Core Entities User Manual

Core Entities User Manual
Core Entities
Oracle FLEXCUBE Universal Banking Europe Cluster
Release 11.3.81.02.0
[October] [2013]
Oracle Part Number E51523-01
Core Entities
Table of Contents
1.
ABOUT THIS MANUAL................................................................................................................................ 1-1
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
2.
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 1-1
AUDIENCE .................................................................................................................................................. 1-1
ORGANIZATION .......................................................................................................................................... 1-1
RELATED DOCUMENTS ............................................................................................................................... 1-2
GLOSSARY OF ICONS .................................................................................................................................. 1-2
MAINTAINING CUSTOMER INFORMATION FILES ............................................................................ 2-1
2.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 2-1
2.2
INVOKING CUSTOMER INFORMATION SCREEN ............................................................................................ 2-1
2.2.1
Maintaining Customer Basic Record ................................................................................................. 2-1
2.2.2
Indicating Main Details ..................................................................................................................... 2-6
2.2.3
Postal Code and Locality Maintenance Screen ............................................................................... 2-11
2.2.4
Postal Code and Locality Summary Screen ..................................................................................... 2-12
2.2.5
Maintaining Customer Address Details ........................................................................................... 2-14
2.2.6
Auxiliary Tab ................................................................................................................................... 2-23
2.2.7
Corporate Tab ................................................................................................................................. 2-30
2.2.8
Personal Tab .................................................................................................................................... 2-32
2.2.9
Check List Tab ................................................................................................................................. 2-36
2.3
CUSTOMER DOCUMENT EXPIRY QUERY SCREEN ..................................................................................... 2-39
2.3.1
Maintaining Domestic Details of Individual Customer ................................................................... 2-40
2.3.2
Maintaining Professional Details of Individual Customers ............................................................. 2-41
2.3.3
Capturing UDF Values for Customers ............................................................................................ 2-44
2.3.4
Special Customer Grouping ............................................................................................................. 2-45
2.3.5
Dictionary Details ........................................................................................................................... 2-47
2.3.6
Specifying Analytical Parameters .................................................................................................... 2-48
2.3.7
Other Basic Customer Information .................................................................................................. 2-50
2.3.8
Viewing Debit Card Details ............................................................................................................. 2-52
2.3.9
Viewing OFAC Check Response ...................................................................................................... 2-53
2.3.10
Viewing KYC Details ....................................................................................................................... 2-54
2.3.11
Maintaining Joint Venture Details ................................................................................................... 2-62
2.3.12
Maintaining Tax Details .................................................................................................................. 2-64
2.4
FINANCIAL INSTITUTION EXEMPTION MAINTENANCE SCREEN ................................................................. 2-65
2.5
FINANCIAL INSTITUTION EXEMPTION SUMMARY SCREEN ........................................................................ 2-67
2.5.2
Maintaining Linked Account ............................................................................................................ 2-71
2.5.3
Maintaining MiFID Classification .................................................................................................. 2-72
2.5.4
Maintaining Employer Details ......................................................................................................... 2-74
2.5.5
Maintaining Province, City and Postal Code Details ...................................................................... 2-75
2.5.6
Maintaining Province, City and Postal Code Summary Details ...................................................... 2-78
2.5.7
Maintaining Customer Sector Details ............................................................................................. 2-78
2.5.8
Maintaining CNAE/CNO Code ........................................................................................................ 2-79
2.5.9
Maintaining CNAE, Sector Code and Customer Type ..................................................................... 2-80
2.5.10
Maintaining Economic Group Code ................................................................................................ 2-81
2.5.11
Maintaining External Bank Details ................................................................................................. 2-82
2.5.12
Viewing External Bank Details ........................................................................................................ 2-84
2.5.13
Maintaining Waiver for Customer Tax Group ................................................................................. 2-84
2.5.14
Maintaining Tax Allowance Limit for Customers ............................................................................ 2-87
2.5.15
Maintaining Church Tax Declaration for a Customer .................................................................... 2-93
2.5.16
Amendment Maintenance ................................................................................................................. 2-96
2.5.17
Specifying Details for Generation of MT920 ................................................................................... 2-99
2.5.18
Invoking Customer Category Screen ............................................................................................. 2-100
2.5.19
Creating Customer Categories ...................................................................................................... 2-101
2.5.20
Maintaining Customer Groups ...................................................................................................... 2-103
2.5.21
Maintaining Limits for Customer Group ....................................................................................... 2-104
2.5.22
Associating Customer Account with Group ................................................................................... 2-104
2.5.23
Maintaining Type of Relationships ................................................................................................ 2-106
2.5.24
Relationships for Customers .......................................................................................................... 2-107
2.5.25
Maintaining Risk Category for Customers .................................................................................... 2-108
2.6
MAINTAINING CHEQUE NOT ALLOWED CUSTOMER DETAILS ................................................................ 2-109
2.7
MULTIPLE RELATIONSHIPS ..................................................................................................................... 2-110
2.7.1
Maintaining Types of Relationships ............................................................................................... 2-110
2.7.2
Maintaining Relationships between Customers ............................................................................. 2-110
2.7.3
Maintaining Customer Groups ...................................................................................................... 2-113
2.7.4
Capturing Customer Prefixes ........................................................................................................ 2-115
2.7.5
Storing Authorized Variations of Customer’s Name ...................................................................... 2-116
2.7.6
Maintaining Float Days for Outward Clearing Customer Transactions ....................................... 2-117
2.7.7
Location Maintenance ................................................................................................................... 2-119
2.7.8
Specifying the Dictionary Details .................................................................................................. 2-119
2.8
MAINTAINING KYC TYPE ...................................................................................................................... 2-121
2.8.1
Specifying KYC Value Details ....................................................................................................... 2-122
2.9
MAINTAINING CUSTOMER KYC DETAILS .............................................................................................. 2-127
2.10 CREATING A MESSAGE ADVICE FORMAT ............................................................................................... 2-140
2.11 VIEWING CUSTOMER DETAILS ............................................................................................................... 2-142
3.
MAINTAINING MANDATORY INFORMATION .................................................................................... 3-1
3.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 3-1
3.2
MAINTAINING ACCOUNT CLASSES ............................................................................................................. 3-1
3.2.1
Invoking Account Class Maintenance Screen .................................................................................... 3-2
3.2.2
Statement Parameters Tab ................................................................................................................. 3-8
3.2.3
Maintaining Cheque Book Preferences ........................................................................................... 3-11
3.2.4
Capturing Details about Specially Designated Nationals ............................................................... 3-12
3.2.5
Specifying your Preferences for Account Class ............................................................................... 3-13
3.2.6
Specifying Liquidation Preferences for Debit Interest and Charges ............................................... 3-19
3.2.7
Maintaining Details for Free Banking ............................................................................................. 3-20
3.2.8
Specifying Initial Funding Preferences............................................................................................ 3-20
3.2.9
Maintaining Provisioning Details.................................................................................................... 3-21
3.2.10
Maintaining Escrow Details ............................................................................................................ 3-21
3.2.11
Maintaining Status Codes for Account Class .................................................................................. 3-22
3.2.12
Specifying Reporting line Details .................................................................................................... 3-23
3.2.13
Maintaining Auto Deposits .............................................................................................................. 3-24
3.2.14
Maintaining Rules for Automatic Status Change ............................................................................. 3-26
3.2.15
Maintaining Sequence for Funds Allocation ................................................................................... 3-32
3.2.16
Maintaining Transaction Restrictions for Account Class ................................................................ 3-35
3.2.17
Maintaining Details of Account Statements Generation .................................................................. 3-35
3.2.18
Specifying Regulation D Applicability for Account Class ............................................................... 3-41
3.2.19
Assigning Preferred Branches, Currencies and Customers ............................................................. 3-41
3.2.20
Maintaining Branch Preferences ..................................................................................................... 3-42
3.2.21
Maintaining Currency Preferences .................................................................................................. 3-43
3.2.22
Maintaining Customer Preferences ................................................................................................. 3-43
3.2.23
Specifying Balance Account Codes .................................................................................................. 3-45
3.2.24
Maintaining Notice Preferences ...................................................................................................... 3-48
3.2.25
Maintaining Account Class Transfer ............................................................................................... 3-49
3.2.26
Processing Account Class Transfer ................................................................................................. 3-67
3.2.27
Viewing Account Class Transfer ...................................................................................................... 3-68
3.2.28 Maintaining Narratives.................................................................................................................... 3-69
3.2.29
Maintaining Customer Instruction Details ...................................................................................... 3-71
3.2.30
Maintaining Lead Details ................................................................................................................ 3-74
3.2.31
Maintaining Service Request Input Details ..................................................................................... 3-77
3.2.32
Viewing Service Request Details ..................................................................................................... 3-80
3.2.33
Maintaining Location Details .......................................................................................................... 3-82
3.2.34
Capturing Algorithm Details in Oracle FLEXCUBE ...................................................................... 3-84
3.2.35
Maintaining Turnover Limits ........................................................................................................... 3-86
3.3
MAINTAINING DEPOSITS INSTRUCTIONS................................................................................................... 3-88
4.
PROCESSING REFERRALS IN ORACLE FLEXCUBE .......................................................................... 4-1
4.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 4-1
4.1.1
Maintenance Required for Referral Processing ................................................................................ 4-3
5.
PROVISIONING FOR CUSTOMER ACCOUNTS .................................................................................... 5-1
5.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 5-1
5.1.1
Specifying Basis for Status Processing .............................................................................................. 5-1
5.1.2
Setting up Customer Groups for Provisioning ................................................................................... 5-2
5.1.3
Setting up Customer Classifications for Status Processing ............................................................... 5-3
5.1.4
Setting up Exposure Categories ......................................................................................................... 5-4
5.1.5
Maintaining Rules for Provisioning................................................................................................... 5-8
5.1.6
Derivation Rules for Status Change .................................................................................................. 5-9
5.2
MAINTAINING PROVISIONING COVERAGE DETAILS .................................................................................. 5-10
5.3
VIEWING PROVISIONING COVERAGE DETAILS.......................................................................................... 5-12
5.4
MAINTAINING RISK LEVEL PROVISIONING RATE ..................................................................................... 5-13
5.5
VIEWING RISK LEVEL PROVISIONING RATE ............................................................................................. 5-15
5.6
MAINTAINING COUNTRY GROUP PROVISIONING RATES ........................................................................... 5-16
5.7
VIEWING COUNTRY GROUP PROVISIONING RATES................................................................................... 5-17
5.8
VIEWING MANUAL PROVISIONING ........................................................................................................... 5-18
5.8.1
Viewing Contract Details ................................................................................................................. 5-20
5.9
PROVISIONING COMPUTATION BATCHES .................................................................................................. 5-20
5.9.1
Provision Processing for Accounts .................................................................................................. 5-21
6.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION QUERY ...................................................................................................... 6-1
6.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 6-1
6.2
INVOKING CUSTOMER POSITION SCREEN ................................................................................................... 6-1
6.2.1
Viewing Account Details .................................................................................................................... 6-2
6.2.2
Viewing Loans Details ....................................................................................................................... 6-3
6.2.3
Viewing Deposit Details .................................................................................................................... 6-5
6.2.4
Viewing FX Details ............................................................................................................................ 6-7
6.2.5
Viewing FT Details ............................................................................................................................ 6-8
6.2.6
Viewing Collaterals Details ............................................................................................................... 6-9
6.2.7
Viewing Assets/Liabilities Details.................................................................................................... 6-10
6.2.8
Viewing Limits Details ..................................................................................................................... 6-12
6.2.9
Viewing MIS Details ........................................................................................................................ 6-12
6.2.10
Viewing Projections ......................................................................................................................... 6-13
6.2.11
Viewing Accounting Entries ............................................................................................................. 6-14
6.2.12
Overdrawn Accounts Query ............................................................................................................. 6-14
6.2.13
Uncollected Funds Query ................................................................................................................ 6-16
6.2.14
Customer Account Balance Query ................................................................................................... 6-16
7.
360 DEGREE CUSTOMER VIEW ............................................................................................................... 7-1
7.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 7-1
7.2
INVOKING 360DEGREE CUSTOMER VIEW ENTRY SCREEN.......................................................................... 7-1
7.3
VIEWING 360 DEGREE RETAIL CUSTOMER DETAILS .................................................................................. 7-2
7.3.1
Viewing Summary Details .................................................................................................................. 7-4
7.3.2
Viewing Profile Details ...................................................................................................................... 7-5
7.3.3
Viewing Deposit Details .................................................................................................................. 7-16
7.3.4
Viewing Loan Details....................................................................................................................... 7-30
7.3.5
Viewing Events Details .................................................................................................................... 7-34
7.3.6
Viewing Schemes Details ................................................................................................................. 7-34
7.3.7
Viewing Alerts .................................................................................................................................. 7-36
7.3.8
Viewing Limits Details ..................................................................................................................... 7-39
7.3.9
Viewing Payment Details ................................................................................................................. 7-41
7.3.10
Viewing Islamic Deposits Details .................................................................................................... 7-42
7.3.11
Viewing Islamic Financing Details .................................................................................................. 7-44
7.3.12
Viewing External Details ................................................................................................................. 7-46
7.4
VIEWING 360DEGREE CORPORATE CUSTOMER DETAILS ......................................................................... 7-48
7.4.1
Viewing Summary Details ................................................................................................................ 7-50
7.4.2
Viewing Profile Details .................................................................................................................... 7-51
7.4.3
Viewing Deposits Details ................................................................................................................. 7-57
7.4.4
Viewing Loan Details....................................................................................................................... 7-64
7.4.5
Viewing Trade Details ..................................................................................................................... 7-67
7.4.6
Viewing Treasury Details ................................................................................................................ 7-74
7.4.7
Viewing Events Details .................................................................................................................... 7-77
7.4.8
Viewing Schemes Details ................................................................................................................. 7-77
7.4.9
Viewing Alerts .................................................................................................................................. 7-79
7.4.10
Viewing Limits Details ..................................................................................................................... 7-79
7.4.11
Viewing Payment Details ................................................................................................................. 7-80
7.4.12
Viewing Islamic Deposits................................................................................................................. 7-81
7.4.13
Viewing Is-Financing Details .......................................................................................................... 7-86
7.4.14
Viewing Islamic Trade Details......................................................................................................... 7-88
7.4.15
Viewing Islamic Treasury Details .................................................................................................... 7-90
7.4.16
Viewing External Details ................................................................................................................. 7-91
8.
GLOSSARY ..................................................................................................................................................... 8-1
8.1
9.
IMPORTANT TERMS .................................................................................................................................... 8-1
REPORTS ........................................................................................................................................................ 9-4
9.1
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.2
IRA STATEMENT REPORTS ......................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.2.1
Selection Options ............................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.2.2
Contents of the Report ....................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.3
MINIMUM WITHDRAWAL ADVICE REPORTS ............................................................................................... 9-3
9.3.1
Contents of the Report ....................................................................................................................... 9-3
9.4
CHARGE ADVICE REPORTS ......................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.4.1
Contents of the Report ....................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.5
IRS FORM 5498 .......................................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.5.1
Generating Form 5498 as Part of Initial Filing ................................................................................ 9-5
9.5.2
Generating Form 5498 after Tax Filing ............................................................................................ 9-5
9.5.3
Details printed on Form 5498............................................................................................................ 9-5
9.6
IRS FORM 1099-R ...................................................................................................................................... 9-6
9.6.1
Generating Form 1099-R as Part of Initial Filing............................................................................. 9-6
9.6.2
Generating Form 1099-R after Tax Filing ........................................................................................ 9-6
9.6.3
Details printed on Form 1099-R ........................................................................................................ 9-6
9.6.4
Filing IRS Forms Electronically ........................................................................................................ 9-7
9.7
CUSTOMER ACCOUNT OPENING CONFIRMATION REPORT .......................................................................... 9-7
9.8
NETTING REPORT ....................................................................................................................................... 9-8
9.8.1
Contents of the Report ....................................................................................................................... 9-9
9.9
COMBINED STATEMENT REPORTS .............................................................................................................. 9-9
9.9.1
Contents of the Report ..................................................................................................................... 9-10
9.10 MISSING SIGNATURE REPORT................................................................................................................... 9-11
9.10.1
Contents of the Report ..................................................................................................................... 9-13
10.
10.1
SCREEN GLOSSARY .............................................................................................................................. 10-1
FUNCTION ID LIST.................................................................................................................................... 10-1
1. About this Manual
1.1
Introduction
This manual is designed to explain the Core Entities module of Oracle FLEXCUBE. It provides an
overview to the module, and provides information on using the Core Entities module of Oracle
FLEXCUBE.
You can further obtain information specific to a particular field by placing the cursor on the
relevant field and striking <F1> on the keyboard.
1.2
Audience
This manual is intended for the following User/User Roles:
1.3
Role
Function
Back office managers/officers
Authorization functions
Product Managers
Product definition and authorization
End of day operators
Processing during end of day/ beginning
of day
Financial Controller/Product
Managers
Generation of reports
Organization
This manual is organized into the following chapters:
Chapter 1
About this Manual acquaints you quickly with the organization,
audience, glossary of icons and related documents for this user
manual
Chapter 2
Maintaining Customer Information Files explains the maintenance
of various personal and business details of the customers of your
bank
Chapter 3
Maintaining Mandatory Information explains how you can classify
customer accounts into different groups known as account
classes, and how to maintain specifications for account classes
Chapter 4
Processing Referrals in Oracle FLEXCUBE details the
maintenance required and the processing done in Oracle
FLEXCUBE when customer transactions force the accounts
1-1
involved the transaction to exceed the overdraft limit
1.4
1.5
Chapter 5
Provisioning for Customer Accounts explains the process of
provisioning for customer accounts in Oracle FLEXCUBE
Chapter 6
360 Degree Customer View explains how you can view and
analyze personal and business details of the customers.
Chapter 7
Customer Information Query explains how queries to retrieve
information on customer accounts can be made
Chapter 8
Glossary contains a list of important terms used in the manual.
Chapter 9
Reports provides a list of reports that can be generated in this
module and also explains their contents.
Related Documents

The Procedures User Manual

The Settlements User Manual
Glossary of Icons
This User Manual may refer to all or some of the following icons:
Icons
Function
New
Copy
Save
Delete
Unlock
Print
Close
Re-open
Reverse
Template
Roll-over
1-2
Icons
Function
Hold
Authorize
Liquidate
Exit
Sign-off
Help
Add row
Delete row
Option List
Confirm
Enter Query
Execute Query
Refer the Procedures User Manual for further details about the icons.
1-3
2.
2.1
Maintaining Customer Information Files
Introduction
In the ‘Customer Maintenance’ screen, you maintain various personal and business details of the
customers of your bank.
The CIF details are maintained at the branch level by the sign-on branch. These details can be
accessed by all branches and therefore a duplicate customer record for a customer in two
different branches need not be maintained.
2.2
Invoking Customer Information Screen
You can invoke the ‘Customer Maintenance’ screen by typing ‘STDCIF’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The four parameters listed on top are the four lines along which you maintain customer details.
These details have been classified into the following broad heads:
Main
You maintain the main attributes of all customers,
individuals and corporate houses
Auxiliary
This screen shows the other details pertaining to the
customer
Personal
You maintain the attributes for individual customers
Corporate
You maintain the attributes for all corporate customers
Custom
You maintain any other corporate customer related
information, which your bank would like to maintain in
addition to the ones defined under Corporate
Analytical
Parameters
You can capture certain parameters related to the
customer which are used for validation purposes
2.2.1 Maintaining Customer Basic Record
To define the basic details of the customer click on the tab titled ‘Main’. The details that you can
specify for a customer depend on the type of customer whose details you are capturing.
If a particular field is disabled, it means that the field is not relevant to the type of customer that
you are creating.
2-1
Select ‘New’ from the Actions menu in the Application toolbar. The system will display
‘Transaction Branch’ screen. Here you can select the transaction branch.
Here you are allowed to book other branch transactions from the logged in branch. Also, you can
query other branch transactions from the logged in branch. Query operation would not be
supported from the online screens for other branch transactions. Other branch transactions can
be query from summary screen only. The system defaults the logged-in branch by default as the
transaction branch. Option to authorize/modify/close other branch customer from the login branch
is also provided.
Transaction Branch
Select the appropriate branch from the list of branches available in the option list. This screen will
be available only for those users who has ‘Multi Branch Operational’ check box enabled at ‘User
Maintenance’ Screen.
While clicking ‘Ok’ button, the system validates the access rights of the selected branch and
function for the user. If you don’t have appropriate rights on the selected branch and function, the
system would raise an error message. If you select a valid branch, the system updates the same
as transaction branch and the transaction would be posted for this branch.
The system performs the action level access rights validation only on ‘Save’ operation.
After selecting the Transaction Branch, you can enter the remaining details in the ‘Customer
Maintenance’ screen.
2-2
2.2.1.1 Specifying Details of Customer
Customer No
The customer code is the code you assign to identify a customer. It is referred to as the customer
CIF Number. This code should be unique across branches. It can be 9-characters long.
Example
Assign a code using a maximum of 9 characters, alphanumeric. For example, assume your customer is
DOW Corporation, US. You can assign him a code, which could either, be a number representing the
customer’s serial number or an alphabetic code like DowCorp or an alphanumeric code like Dow1000US or
DowUS1000 / 1000DowUS, if he is the 1000th customer to approach your bank.
Short Name
Along with the Customer Code you have to capture the customer’s abbreviated name. The
description that you capture is unique for each customer. It helps in conducting a quick alphasearch or generating queries regarding the customer.
Enter the abbreviated name of the customer using a maximum of 20 characters, alphanumeric.
Taking the same example, assume your customer is DOW Corporation. Its short name could be
DOWCORP.
2-3
At the time of processing of transactions (and in any activity which requires entry of the customer
identification), in addition to the customer code, the short name of the customer that you enter
here will be available in the options list from which the customer is selected.
Branch Code
Specify the branch code from the adjoining option list.
Liability Number
The credit facility granted to any customer is tracked against this Liability Number of the
customer.
The default liability number of a customer is the same as his customer code. However, you have
the option of tracking the credit limit of this customer against an existing liability number (for
another customer).
Thus if the liability number of the customer is the same as the customer’s code, it implies that the
liability granted to the customer is exclusive to the particular customer. Conversely, if the liability
number of a customer is different from the customer code, it implies that the liability of the specific
customer is tracked against a parent customer.
This parameter helps you to assign the same liability structure for a group of customers. This
feature is useful when you have several subsidiary companies/divisions reporting to the same
parent company.
Example
While assigning a liability number to Opel Motors, Germany a subsidiary of General Motors, US you can
track the liability of Opel Motors against General Motors.
Full Name
You can specify the full name of the customer in this field.
Joint Venture
Check this box if the customer is a joint venture customer. For joint venture customers, the
system will capture the parties in the joint venture and their ratios during joint venture
maintenance.
Type
You have to indicate the Type to which the customer whose details you are capturing belongs.
The options available are:

Individual

Corporate

Bank
2-4
To recall, if a customer record is created from an external Siebel CRM application after a
successful upload into Oracle FLEXCUBE, the ‘CRM Customer’ flag gets checked after the
upload. You can however, uncheck the same when you unlock such a record and make changes.
When you unlock such a record, system throws up an override stating that the customer is a
CRM customer and asks whether you want to continue modifying the record. If you confirm the
same, Oracle FLEXCUBE allows you to make changes. If you choose to ignore, the original
record is saved.
Private Customer
Check this box to indicate that the customer type is private.
Customer Sub Type
Specify the customer sub-type. The adjoin option list displays the valid customer sub-types
maintained in the system. Select the appropriate one.
It is mandatory to specify customer sub-type the customer type is ‘Corporate’.
Description
System displays the description based on the selected ‘Customer Sub-type’.
Document ID Type
Specify the type of document Id from the adjoining option list. It is not mandatory to maintain the
document ID for the minor customers who are below 14 years.
The option list will display the following values for Spain:

NIE

NIF

DNI
Document ID Number
Specify the document ID number.
For Spain, system validates based on the type of document selected with pre-defined
algorithms.
2-5
2.2.2 Indicating Main Details
CLS Participant
Customers of your bank can settle their FX deals via the CLS (Continuous Linked Settlements)
Bank to reduce the risks associated with such transactions. To allow the customers to do CLS
trades, you have to mark the customer as a ‘CLS Participant’. However, you have to ensure that
the branch at which the customer operates is also qualified to process CLS deals i.e. the branch
should also be marked as a CLS Participant before allowing the same for the customer.
Further, you can also capture currency restrictions for your customers by maintaining a list of
allowed or disallowed currencies for CLS trading. Click the ‘CLS Restrictions’ button to maintain
this list. Note that currency restrictions will be allowed only for customers who are CLS
participants.
Refer the ‘Continuous Linked Settlements’ chapter of the Foreign Exchange User Manual for
details on maintaining currency restrictions and other maintenances required for processing CLS
deals in Oracle FLEXCUBE.
MT920
Check this option to indicate that the customer is eligible to request for MT920 messages.
MT920-Account Update Request-A request for an up-to-date statement from the bank where the
referenced Account is held. The request may be for an Intra Day Update (MT942) or an End of
Day Update (MT940) and is subject to the service agreed with that bank.
Issuer Customer
If the customer whose CIF you are maintaining is an issuer of securities, then check this box.
Relationship Pricing
Select this checkbox to indicate that the customer is eligible for relationship pricing. This
checkbox will be unselected by default.
For more details on relationship pricing, refer Relationship Pricing user manual
Staff
Check this box whenever a customer record is created for a staff. By default this box is left
unchecked.
ELCM Customer
Check this box to replicate the customer details to ELCM system. By default, system checks this
box whenever the new customer is created. You can uncheck this box if required so that
customer data will not get replicated to ELCM system.
Once you select the option ‘ELCM customer’, system will not allow you to unselect it.
2-6
ELCM Customer Number
You need to specify the ELCM customer number if the option ‘Generate Customer Number’ is not
selected in ‘ELCM Parameter Maintenance’ screen. If the option ‘Generate Customer Number’ is
selected in ‘ELCM Parameter Maintenance’ screen, then the system will replicate the customer
number from ELCM system.
2.2.2.1 Specifying Geographical Details
As part of specifying the Geographical details of the Customer, you have to capture the following
details:
Language
As part of maintaining customer accounts and transacting on behalf of your customer, you will
need to send periodic updates to your customers in the form of advices, statement of accounts
and so on.
You have to indicate the language in which your customer wants the statements and advices to
be generated. English is defaulted as the language of correspondence; you have the option to
change the default. The list positioned next to the language field contains all the language codes
maintained in the SMS module. You can select the appropriate.
Country
This is the country as given in the address of correspondence of this customer. Click on the
option list positioned next to this field, a list of countries maintained in the Country Codes screen
is displayed. You can select the appropriate. Specify if the customers are resident/Non-resident
for validation. The system checks the user entered country code with the branch country code
and if both are equal then the user is allowed to select the resident status as resident else the
user can only select the residential status as non resident.
Nationality
Specify the nationality of the customer. The list of country codes maintained in the Country Codes
Maintenance screen are available in the option-list positioned next to this field. You can select the
appropriate.
Exposure
This is the country of exposure of this customer. It is maintained for Central Liability tracking. For
instance, for Toyota in the USA, the country of exposure is Japan.
Location
Each customer code should be associated with a location code. The location is indicative of the
place of residence of your customer.
The option list positioned next to this field contains a list of all the location codes maintained in
the Location Details maintenance screen. You can select the appropriate code to identify the
place of residence of your customer.
2-7
Given below is an illustration of how a location code is associated with the CIF record of a
customer
Example
You would like to maintain the CIF details of your customer Silas Marner. Although Silas Marner is Irish, he
is a resident of London and lives in the northern part of London. Your entries in the respective fields of the
CIF Maintenance screen should be as follows:
Fields in Oracle FLEXCUBE
Your entry
Customer Code
SILAS01
Nationality
IRS (Ireland)
Location Code
NL1 (North London)
2.2.2.2 Resident Status
Indicate the resident status of this customer. Whether the customer is a recognized resident of
the country in which the particular branch of your bank operates. You can modify this field even
after authorization.
For the customers classified as Residents, i.e. Country = ‘PT’, it is necessary to determine if the
customer is resident of ‘01 Portugal Mainland’, ‘02 Azores Islands’ or ‘03 Madeira Island’ based
on the Region code maintained on the Customer Maintenance screen.
For the customers classified as Non-Resident, it is necessary to determine if the customer is
resident in an ADT Country or in Other Country, based on the ADT identifier introduced on the
Country Code Maintenance Screen.
Resident status gets validated based on a system logic, which checks the Customer Country
Code and the Branch Country Code.
If Customer Country Code is same as Branch Country Code, then the Customer Resident Status
is ‘Resident’. If you specify the Resident Status as ‘Non-Resident’, then the system displays error
message, hence enforcing the user to select the value as ‘Resident’.
If Customer Country Code is different from Branch Country Code, then the Customer Resident
Status is ‘Non-Resident’. If you specify Resident Status as ‘Resident’, then the system displays
error message, hence enforcing the user to select the value as ‘Non-Resident’.
2.2.2.3 Document Expiry
If the customer is a Non-resident, residing in an 'ADT Country' or in 'Other Country', 'ADT
Certificate' and 'Non Resident Proof', indicate the expiry status or availability of the documents.
2-8
ADT Certificate
If ‘ADT Certificate’ is checked, it indicates that the document 'Certificate for ADT (ADT – 21RFI)'
is either expired or is not attached. System automatically updates it.
Non Resident Proof
‘If ‘Non Resident Proof’ is checked, it indicates that the document 'Proof of residence' is either
expired or is not attached.. System automatically updates it. For a customer residing in Other
Country, this flag is checked if the document 'Proof of Residence' is expired or is not attached.
For all other cases this flag remains unchecked.
Flags 'ADT Certificate' & 'Non Resident Proof' are auto updated by the system & are not
modifiable by the user.
2.2.2.4 Indicating Address for Correspondence
Name
In the lines that are provided you can enter the name of the customer. The customer will be
addressed by this name in all correspondence sent from the bank. These characters should
conform to SWIFT standards.
The number of characters that you can enter in this field is determined by the preference that
you specified in the Bank Parameters screen. However, in the advices and statements that are
sent to the customer only the first 35 characters of the name will be displayed.
Street Details
Specify the street details such as street name and number as a part of the customer address.
Province/Region Code
Specify the province or region of the customer. The adjoining option list displays the list of
province or regions maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate
one.
If Ukraine is selected as the country, then it is mandatory to specify the region.
District Code
Specify the district code from the adjoining option list. The adjoining option list displays the list of
districts maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
City
Specify the city of the customer. The adjoining option list displays the list of city names
maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
2-9
Postal Code
Specify the postal code. The adjoining option list displays the list of postal codes maintained in
the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen for a country and also in the ‘Postal Code Maintenance’
screen. The locality maintained in the ‘Postal Code Maintenance’ screen is a return field. Select
the appropriate option..
Locality
If postal code maintained in 'Postal Code Maintenance Screen' is chosen from the adjoining
option list, the locality corresponding to the Postal Code gets defaulted as per maintenance done
in the 'Postal Code Maintenance Screen'. You can modify the defaulted locality.
If postal code maintained in 'Province City Maintenance' Screen is chosen from the adjoining
option list, no value gets defaulted in the locality field.
Tax ID
Specify the tax identification number of the customer. The Tax ID number, in Portugal, is
assigned by the Ministry of Finance and Public Administration to uniquely identify a tax entity or a
contributor, for exclusive use in the treatment of tax information. When the bank user enters Tax
ID number, system validates its check-digit, to assure that the ID number introduced is a valid
Tax ID number.
System does not allow the same Tax ID number for different customers as Tax ID is unique
identifier for each customer. Tax ID is applicable to Individual/Corporate/Bank clients, either
resident or non residents in Portugal. System displays an error message and does not allow the
user to save the record, if Tax ID number is not unique.
Tax ID specified is validated if branch level parameter 'Tax ID validation' flag is checked.
Financial Institution Type
Select the financial institution type from the adjoining option list. Adjoining option list displays the
Financial Institution Types maintained in the Financial Institution Exemption Maintenance’ screen.
Option for Aggregation
Check this box to indicate, if a non-resident individual customer opts for income aggregation.
Swift Code
You can choose to associate a SWIFT Code with the customer whose CIF details you are
maintaining. This code will be used to send all SWIFT related messages to the customer. This is
pertinent while creating CIF record for banks as customers.
Fax
You can specify the Fax Number of the Customer whose CIF details you are maintaining. This
will be used for faxing the LC confirmation mail message copy to the Counterparty.
2-10
Credit Rating
Specify valid credit rating for a Customer number from the adjoining option list.
Credit rating basically indicates the credit worthiness of the customers linked to a particular credit
line. It is used primarily for information only. The Limits Services Module also uses it in generation
of reports.
Country
Specify the country code of the country to which the customer’s correspondence address
belongs. The adjoining option list displays all the country codes that are maintained in the
system.
Building
Specify the building number of the customer’s correspondence address.
Block
Specify the block number of the customer’s correspondence address.
Apartment (Office) Number
Specify the apartment (office) number of the customer’s correspondence address.
Zip Code
Specify the zip code of the customer’s correspondence address.
Mobile Number
Specify the mobile number of the customer.
Field 50F of outgoing МТ103 message contains the customer address details. The first line of
50F has the customer’s name and the second line of field 50F is populated with Address_Line1,
which in turn contain the details of Street, Building, and Apartment No of the customer. Similarly,
third line of 50F contains Address_Line2 i.e., ‘Country, and Region’, fourth line of 50F contains
Address_Line3 i.e., Block, Locality and fifth line of 50F contains Address_Line4 i.e., District, Zip
Code.
2.2.3 Postal Code and Locality Maintenance Screen
You can invoke the ‘Postal Code and Locality Maintenance’ screen by typing ‘STDPLMNT’ in the
field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Postal Code and Locality Maintenance screen maintains the Postal Code and Locality
information.
2-11
Postal Code and Locality Details
Country Code
Select the country code from the adjoining list of options.
Postal Code
Specify the postal code. Structure of postal code is NNNN-NNN. Postal codes are unique for the
specified country.
Locality
Specify the locality corresponding to the postal code.
2.2.4 Postal Code and Locality Summary Screen
You can invoke the ‘Postal Code and Locality Summary’ screen by typing ‘STSPLMNT’ in the
field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Postal Code and Locality Summary screen maintains the Postal Code and Locality summary
information.
Navigation:
Core Entity > Postal Code and Locality View
2-12
Authorization Status
Select the authorization status from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Authorized

Unauthorized

Rejected
Record Status
Select the record status from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Open

Closed
Country
Select the country from the adjoining option list.
Postal Code
Select the postal code from the adjoining option list. Value entered follows the ‘Search and Fetch’
mechanism.
2-13
Locality
Select the locality from adjoining option list. Value entered follows the ‘Search and Fetch’ mechanism.
2.2.5 Maintaining Customer Address Details
You can maintain the customer address details in ‘Customer Address Maintenance’ screen..You
can invoke this screen by typing ‘MSDCUSAD’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application
tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can specify the following details in this screen:
Customer Number
It is the relevant customer account number in the current branch against which you are
maintaining an address, based on a selected media and location. The branch code gets defaulted
alongside.
2-14
A single customer can have any number of accounts. You can choose to link a specific location
with an account number. Maintaining multiple locations for the customer facilitates the sending of
interest and account statements to more than one address of the customer.
If an address is maintained at the Customer Account Definition level, all statements pertaining to
the particular account will be sent only to the address specified at the account level, irrespective
of the message and location maintenance for the Customer.
Location
As discussed earlier, a customer of your bank can have several addresses for the same media.
To differentiate between one address of a customer account and another for a given media, it is
mandatory for you to select a unique location for each address. The location that you specify for
an address is used as a unique identifier for the customer account address.
The values made available against the option list here are maintained through the ‘Account
Address Location Maintenance’ screen.
Refer to the section ‘Location Maintenance’ in the chapter titled ‘Maintaining Customer Accounts’
in the Core Entities (CE) User Manual for relevant information.
Country
Specify the country code of the country to which the customer’s correspondence address
belongs. The adjoining option list displays all the country codes that are maintained in the
system.
Answer Back
Specify the answerback code for the customer. This field is applicable only if a message is
transmitted through ‘Telex'. It cannot be more than 20 characters in length. It is a free format text.
Add Hold Mail Text
If this box is checked, then all the mail advice generated for this customer and location would
have the hold mail text displayed on top of the message. As a consequence, these mail advices
would not be dispatched to the customer unless required. Check this box to indicate you want
the hold mail text to be displayed on top of the message.
To recall, you maintain a hold mail text through the 'Messaging Branch Parameter Maintenance'
screen.
This field is applicable only if the media is ‘MAIL’.
Name
Specify the name of the customer for whom you are maintaining the address details. This
address maintenance is for a particular customer account based on a unique media and location
combination.
2-15
Street Details
Specify the street details such as street name and number as a part of the customer address.
City
Specify the city of the customer. The adjoining option list displays the list of city names
maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
Province
Specify the province of the customer. The adjoining option list displays the list of province
maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
Postal Code
Specify the postal code. The adjoining option list displays the list of postal codes maintained in
the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
Media
Select the media code for which you want to set-up addresses. Choose a code from the optionlist of valid media codes maintained in the ‘Media Maintenance’ screen.
A customer of your bank can have several addresses for a particular media. The media
supported include:

Mail

E-Mail

Telex

SWIFT

FAX

FILEACT(this is an interface to the TIPA network)
Each media type is identified by a 15 character Media Code.
Language
In this screen you can specify the language in which the messages sent to the address should be
expressed. You can choose a language code from the factory shipped option list available for this
field.
The language code that you specify is taken to be the default language in which all messages
sent to the address will be expressed.
To send a message to a customer in a particular language you should have also maintained
a message format for the language in the ‘Advice File Maintenance’ screen.
2-16
Test Keyword
Specify the test word allotted to a customer. This field is applicable only if the message is
transmitted through Telex (ie. media is TELEX).
Delivery By
Select how statements sent to the customer by mail should be delivered from the adjoining option
list.
All the values maintained through the ‘Message Location Maintenance’ screen will be displayed in
the option list.
Send By Email
If your customer has an e-mail address, you can opt to capture it by clicking on the box adjacent
to the ‘Send by E-Mail’ option. Enter the e-mail address for the selected customer account, media
and location combination in the first line of the Address field. You can capture addresses such as
fax, mail, etc, for different media and location combinations.
2.2.5.1 Specifying Unique Identifier Details
Each customer is required to provide certain identification details to your bank for establishing the
customer’s identity. For instance, the passport number or ration card of the customer may serve
as the criteria to establish the customer’s identity. In Oracle FLEXCUBE, this is known as Unique
Identifier Name.
Name
Enter the identifier name in not more than 20 characters.
Value
You have to capture the serial number or any number of significance that is to be associated with
the document, which can help in identifying the document. You can use a maximum of 20
alphanumeric characters, to capture the identifier value.
Identification Code
Specify the unique USREOU code of the customer.The value specified here cannot be less than
8 digits in length.
**A check digit is calculated for the last digit of the code and if this check digit is not equal to the
last digit, then an error message gets displayed. .**Check digit is not the last digit, it is 8th digit of
8 numeric identification code.
This is applicable only for ‘Corporate’ type of customers
Example 1:
A corporate customer has USREOU code 14903012.
2-17
The check digit is the eighth digit of the code and equals to 2.
To check if the check digit “2” is correct for this code:
Di = (1,4,9,0,3,0,1)
Wi = (1,2,3,4,5,6,7)
= 1*1 + 2*4 + 3*9 +4*0 + 5*3 + 6*0 + 7*1 = 58,
|S/11|=|58/11| = 5 (remainder 2),
CD = 58-11*5=3.
Hence, the check digit “3” in code 14903013 is correct
Note the following:

Blank value of the code is permissible.

If the value of the field is not “blank” and the length of the ID is less than 8 digits, the
system will generate an error message.
For ‘Individual’ type of customers you need to specify the unique identification code, not less than
10 digits in length.
The value specified for ‘Individual’ type of customers needs to satisfy the following conditions:

The first five digits of the identification code should be equal to the number of days from
31 December 31, 1899 to the customer's date of birth. The following override message
will be displayed, if this condition is not met:
“Date of Birth is incorrect. Please check date of birth or Customer's Tax ID."

If the customer is male, the next-to-last digit of identification code should be odd. If this
validation fails, the system displays the following override message:
“The ninth digit of identification code should be odd.”

If the customer is female, the next-to-last digit of identification code should be even. If this
validation fails, the system displays the following override message:
“The ninth digit of identification code should be even.”

If the value of the field is not “blank” and the length of ID is less than 10 digits, the system
should generate an error message. The system must not save CIF. “Blank” value of the
code is permissible
This is applicable only for Ukraine and if you have selected the country code of the current
branch as ‘UA’
2-18
2.2.5.2 Indicating Customer/Customer Account Status
As part of indicating the personal status of the customer or the customer’s account, you have to
specify whether the customer has:

Deceased

The customer’s whereabouts are unknown

Whenever Minor Customer attains Majority, and if he/she doesn’t have a valid Document
ID, then system will mark that Customer as Frozen during the EOD. After submitting the
valid Document ID the user has to manually uncheck the ‘Frozen’ check box.
For each customer you will be allowed to mark one or more statuses. For example, if the
customer has deceased then the customer account will be declared frozen. Therefore, for the
particular customer both the statuses ‘Deceased’ and ‘Frozen’ will be applicable.
If none of the statuses is marked, it suggests that this customer’s status is normal.
Customer Category
Each customer that you maintain can be categorized under any one of the categories that you
have maintained in the Customer Category Maintenance screen. Select from the list and indicate
the Category under which the particular customer is to be categorized.
You need to capture the basic details for each customer, regardless of the type of customer
you are maintaining.
Black Listed
System checks this field to indicate that the customer is black listed. The system validates the
customer against the Black Listed Customers Data file and throws an override message as
follows.
Black Listed customer, Proceed?
In case the customer is not present in the Black Listed Customers Data file, this field remains
unchecked
By default the field is unchecked.
2.2.5.3 Specifying Group to which Customer Belongs
When you maintain CIF details for customers, in the Customer Maintenance screen, you can
specify the customer group, to which the customer belongs, for:
Economic Group Code
Specify the economic group code. The adjoining option list displays the list of all the valid
economic group codes maintained in the ‘Economic Group Codes Maintenance’ screen. Select
the appropriate one.
2-19
Note the following:

You can select the same economic group code for more than one customer.

It is mandatory to maintain the economic group code for the individual and Corporate
customer type.
Group Code
You must specify a group code defined for a group type that is the same as the customer type, for
instance, if the customer is a retail customer, you must specify a group defined for retail
customers.
Charge Group
Specify the charge group of the customer from the option list provided. Only the Group codes
maintained with type Charge will appear for selection.
Clearing Group
Categorize the customer for levying charges at a customer group level.
Tax Group
You need to specify the tax group of the customer from the option list provided. Only the Group
Codes maintained with type Tax will appear for selection.
For tax group modification, the system displays an override message if there is an
outstanding utilization for the current tax cycle.
Sector Code
Specify the sector code. The adjoining option list displays the list of all the valid sector codes
maintained in the ‘Customer Sector Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one. You can
modify this field even after authorization.
Sector Description
System displays the brief description of the selected sector code.
Withholding Tax
This box is checked by default if the customer is resident. If non-resident, system checks If any of
the following types of certificates expires, then the system checks this box and applies
withholding tax during further interest liquidation:

‘FISCAL’ – for Fiscal Declaration Certificate

‘CONSULAR’ – for Councillor Certificate

‘POLICE’ – for Police Certificate
2-20
Also, system generates the mail message ‘WHT_EXPIRY’ – Withholding Tax Document Expiry to
the customer before three months of the document expiry date advising them to re-submit the
document to avoid withholding tax.
System checks this box based on the validity of the certificate; however, you will have to manually
uncheck this box during initial customer creation or any further updating of certificate renewal.
System will stop withholding tax from the time the box is unchecked and will pay the collected tax
to the tax agency.
Irrespective of the customer status change from ‘Resident’ to ‘Non-resident’ or from ‘Nonresident’ to ‘Resident’, system will consider the check box ‘Withholding Tax Applicable’ to decide
whether to apply withholding tax or not.
An SDE ‘WHT_APPLICABLE’ checks the box ‘Withholding Tax Applicable’ if the withholding tax
is applicable.
A UDE ‘WHT_RATE’ is defined as per the different tax rate depending on the state in which the
branch is located.
During BOD system triggers the batch ‘STBWHTPR’ – ‘Withholding Tax Process Batch’ to check
if any of the above mentioned documents are expired. If any certificate is expired, then the
system checks this box and the withholding tax will be applicable.
SSN
While maintaining the details of an individual type of customer you can capture the social security
number (SSN) of the customer. While processing funds transfer on behalf of your customer the
SS Number of the customer involved in the transaction will be defaulted from this screen to FT
Contract Online screen.
If the value of debits (outgoing customer transfers) for a specific customer account exceeds USD
2500, with-in a seven-day working period the system displays an override message informing you
of the same.
Example
th
Let us assume that on the 24 of September 2001, Mrs. Wendy Klien a customer of your bank initiates an
outgoing FT for USD 2000. Since all weekends are considered as holidays at your bank, while processing
th
th
the transfer all debits against her account for six working days preceding the 24 i.e., up to the 16
September will be tracked against her SS number.
st
Again, on the 1 of October 2001, she initiates another outgoing transfer, which necessitates a deduction of
st
USD 700 on her account. While processing the transfer the system checks for all debits upto the 21 of
September.
th
An amount of USD 2000 has already been tracked against her SS number on the 24 of September.
However, since the current debit exceeds the maximum limit of USD 2500 for a running seven-day working
period the transfer will be processed only if you confirm the override.
2-21
FX Nett. Customer
Oracle FLEXCUBE provides the facility of netting, currency wise or currency-pair wise and
sending messages to the head office or a designated branch for a group of counterparties
belonging to the same group.
All transactions meant to be settled on a particular day that are made before cut-off day are
collated, netted and a single payment message is sent which called ‘Netting days’ in Oracle
FLEXCUBE.
Here you specify the FX netting customer to whom the netted FX message shall be sent. For
customers not belonging to any group, the FX netting customer will be the same as the customer
of the maintenance.
Withholding Tax Pct
Specify the percentage of tax that should be withheld from the interest that is paid to the bank by
the customer. This witholding tax percent is dictated by the country of the customer.
This is applicable for Bearing and Amortized loan contracts also.
KYC Reference Number
Specify the KYC Reference Number. The option list displays all valid KYC reference numbers
generated. Choose the appropriate one. The system will link the KYC details of the selected
reference number to the customer CIF.
KYC refers to Know Your Customer. KYC details for customers are maintained using KYC
Details screen. The system generates a KYC Reference Number during this maintenance.
2.2.5.4 Specifying Exposure Category and Provisioning Details for Customers
When you maintain CIF details for customers, in the Customer Maintenance screen, you can
specify the following exposure category details:

Customer group to which the customer belongs, for provisioning and status processing.
You must specify a group code defined for a group type that is the same as the customer
type, for instance, if the customer is a retail customer, you must specify a group defined
for retail customers

Exposure category under which exposure due to loans issued to the CIF and the
accounts of the CIF will be tracked. The exposure category is derived by the End of Day
batch program and displayed, if the applicable logic has been maintained for the
specified customer-provisioning group, in the Exposure Type Category Linkage
maintenance. If no logic has been maintained for the group, you can specify the
applicable exposure category

Financial standing classification
2-22
Status for the CIF
If status processing for your branch is being done at Group/CIF level (as specified in the Branch
Parameters), the current status assigned to all loans issued to the CIF as well as all overdraft
accounts belonging to the CIF, is displayed in the CIF Status field in the Customer Maintenance
screen. This status is the worst status of all loans contracts and overdraft accounts for a
Group/CIF and is displayed both at the account as well as the loan level for all the accounts and
loans a customer has in the current branch. The update applies only to the accounts and loans in
the current branch not across branches.
The date since which the loans issued to the CIF (as well as the customer accounts belonging to
the CIF with outstanding overdrafts) moved into the current status, is also displayed.
Note the following:

The status change maintenance and movement change should be similarly set up for all
loan products and accounts. If it is not the same across all loan products, then the worst
status update will not happen for the dissimilar products.

Status change update is done only for accounts where the movement type selected is
either ‘Auto’ or ‘Both’ and is done by the status change batch which will be run after the
CL batch. The status change batch uses the worst status derived by the CL batch for the
update.
For details about loan status processing and provisioning, consult the Loans user manual. For
details about account provisioning, refer to the chapter ‘Provisioning for Customer Accounts’ in
this user manual.
External Ref No
To recall, if a customer record is created from an external Siebel CRM application after a
successful upload into Oracle FLEXCUBE, the external reference number is defaulted in the
‘External Ref No’ field. You can amend the same when you unlock a record and make changes.
2.2.6 Auxiliary Tab
Click the Auxiliary tab to provide the auxiliary details pertaining to the customer.
2-23
AML Reporting
As a CIF level parameter, you can specify whether AML Reporting is required for the customer.
You can check the box positioned next to this field to indicate that AML reporting should be done
for the customer whose details you are maintaining.
Required
Check this box to indicate that AML Reporting is required. Acode assigned to the customer
whose details you are maintaining is defaulted to the Customer Group field since the system
recognizes each customer code as a customer group. You can choose to either categorize the
customer under the same group or choose another customer group.
If you leave the box unchecked, the system will suppress the generation of AML reports for
the customer.
Consolidated Certificate Required
Check this box to indicate whether a consolidated tax certificate is required for all transactions
done for a given tax cycle. This option would work in conjunction with a similar option in the Tax
Category screen and the Tax Details screen accessed from the Branch Parameters Detail
screen.
2-24
Generating Consolidated Tax Certificate
Depending on the frequency maintained at the branch level, the system will generate the
Consolidated Tax Certificate for a customer, provided the consolidated tax certificate generation
is required at the customer level and the option is maintained at the Tax Category level. The Tax
Certificate will be in a pre-shipped advice format and printed on a Year to Date basis
Maintaining Elements for Advice Generation
The following elements will be available for advice generation for consolidated tax certificates.
Element Name
Description
Data Type
CUSTOMERNO
The customer number for
which the tax summary
certificate is printed
Alphanumeric
CUSTOMERNAME
The customer name
Alphanumeric
FROMDATE
The from date for which the
certificate is generated
Date
TODATE
The to date for which the
certificate is generated
Date
TXNNUMBER
The contract reference
number
Alphanumeric 16
characters
CALCDATE
The tax calculation date
Date
TAXCCY
The tax currency
Alphanumeric 3
characters
TAXAMTINTAXCCY
The tax amount in tax
currency
Number
INTERESTAMT
The interest amount (basis
amount on which the tax has
been calculated
Number
2-25
Individual Certificate Required
Check this box to indicate whether an individual tax certificate is required for each transaction. An
individual tax certificate is a certificate (advice) which is generated for each individual event (in a
transaction) resulting in computation/deduction of tax from the customer’s account. The advice is
linked to the product and is generated at the time of authorization of the contract/event.
Generating Individual Tax Certificate
For contracts that have tax defined on interest liquidation, an individual tax certificate will be
generated by the system, provided the tax certificate is linked as an advice for the event and the
individual transaction tax certificate is required to be generated for the customer.
For income other than through interest on customer accounts, the advice format for the tax
certificate can be maintained depending on the requirement. This advice format can be linked to
the products.
For income through interest on customer accounts, the advice format for the tax certificate is preshipped. The format of the advice can be modified except for the name of the advice format which
is pre-shipped.
2-26
Maintaining Tags for Advice Generation
The following tags will be available for advice generation for individual transaction.
Tag Name
Description
Data Type
TXNNUMBER
The contract
reference number
Alphanumeric 16 characters
CALCDATE
The tax calculation
date
Date
COMPCCY
The interest
component currency
Alphanumeric 3 characters
TAXCCY
The tax currency
Alphanumeric 3 characters
TAXAMTINTAXCCY
The tax amount in tax
currency
Number
INTERESTAMT
The interest amount
(basis amount on
which the tax has
been calculated)
Number
Utility Provider
Utility Providers are the recipients of the bill payment. Typical entities involved in a bill payment
transaction are the consumer, your bank and the institutions (utility providers).
Utility Provider
Check this box if the customer whose details you are maintaining happens to be a Utility Provider
Utility Provider Id
Assign a unique ID to identify the utility provider.
Check Digit Validation Required
Check this box to indicate whether the check digit validation should be performed for the
consumer number that is captured while making bill payment for the utility provider.
2-27
Algorithm ID
If the check digit validation should be performed you must also identify the Algorithm ID, which is
used to perform the check digit validation on the consumer number.
Utility Provider Type
Indicate the type of utility provider. The option list adjoining ‘Utility Provider Type’ displays all valid
utility provider types maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate one.
Head Office
Account Number
The Head Office Account Number is the customer’s account number with the Head Office of your
bank. You need to capture this value only if the Customer Type is a ‘Bank’. It is used only for
reference purposes.
Debtor Catagory
Specify the category of the Debtor from the adjoining option list.
Risk Profile
Specify the risk profile from the adjoining option list.
FT Accounting As of
For funds transfer contracts involving certain customers, you may need to generate messages on
the booking date of the contract, while the actual accounting may be deferred to the debit value
date.
This facility could be required in respect of future dated funds transfers involving specific
customers for which the requisite messages need to be sent on booking the contract itself,
whereas posting of accounting entries must be deferred to the debit value date.
You can indicate whether such a facility of allowing message generation before accounting is
available for the customer, in the FT Accounting As Of field. You have the following options for
accounting for FT contracts:

Accounting as of message date (accounting entries will be posted on the date of
message generation)

Debit Value Date (accounting entries will be posted on the debit value date)
Trade Collateral Margin
Trade Collateral Margin value indicates the collateral percent which will be defaulted when the
customer becomes a party to the LC. If Collateral margin is maintained at both product level and
customer level, then the customer level Collateral percent gets precedence and gets defaulted to
LC collateral subsystem.
2-28
Customer collateral margin will also be used in collection Bills not under LC. Collateral amount
will be calculated using customer collateral margin and populated to field collateral amount under
details tab, in bill online screen
Cheques
Specify the following details here:
Cheque Allowed
Specify that the customer is eligible to use the cheque. You can select one of the following
options from the drop-down list:

Yes – If you select yes, then the bank can issue the cheque book to that customer.
Moreover, system will not allow you to maintain the ‘Start Date’ and the ‘End Date’.

No – If you select no, then you need to maintain the ‘Start Date’ and the ‘End Date’.
Customer can neither use any of the issued cheque books nor you can issue new
cheques to that customer in the specified period.
If you select 'No' for Cheque Allowed and if the cheque is already issued, then the system will
display the following override message:
'Unused cheque for all customer accounts will be cancelled’
On authorization, the system will cancel all the unused cheques of the customer.
If you amend the customer and select 'Yes' for Cheque Allowed, the status of the cancelled
cheque will not change.
During BOD, the batch STCIFCHQ will change the value of this field to ‘Yes’ if the system date is
greater than the end date.
Start Date
Specify the date from which the customer is not allowed to use the cheque. Alternatively, you can
also select the date from the calendar button. The start date can be lesser than or equal to the
application date.
End Date
Specify the date up to which the customer is not allowed to use the cheque. Alternatively, you can
also select the date from the calender button. The end date can be greater than or equal to the
start date.
2-29
2.2.7
Corporate Tab
Click the ‘Corporate Details’ tab from the ‘Customer Maintenance’ screen to define the details of a
Corporate or a Bank type of customer.
In this screen, you can maintain the following details for a corporate or bank type customer:
Name
Specify the full name of the main office of the Corporate/Bank customer.
National ID
Specify the corporate National Identification Number of this customer., in other words the
registration number of your customer organization.
Country
Specify the country of the Corporate/Bank customer. You can also select the country from the
adjoining option list.
2-30
Region
Specify the region of the Corporate/Bank customer. You can also select the region from the
adjoining option list.
If Ukraine is selected as the country, then it is mandatory to specify the region.
Issued By
Specify the name of the authority that issued the National ID.
Incorporation
Date
Specify the date on which the customer’s company was registered as an organization.
Capital
Enter the valid amount of total paid-up capital of this customer.
Constitution City
Specify the city name where the corporate customer is established.
Constitution Province
Specify the state name where the corporate customer is established.
Net Worth
This is the total net worth amount of this customer, you input in the customer code field. Enter the
valid amount of total net worth amount of this customer.
Country
Specify the Country of registration of the office of the corporate.
Currency of Amounts
Specify the Currency in which you specify the particular customer’s various financial details like
the Net worth of the customer organization, the total Paid Up capital etc.
Description of Business
Specify the nature of the business and the business activities carried out by the customer
organization.
Directors
Specify the list of the names of the Board of Directors of the organization.
2-31
2.2.8 Personal Tab
If your customer, for whom you have defined parameters in the ‘CIF-basic’ screen, is an
‘individual, you also have to maintain the personal details in order to determine the credit line.
Click the ‘Personal’ tab from the CIF Maintenance screen to maintain these details.
In this screen, you can maintain generic personal details of a customer. In addition, you can also
maintain the domestic and professional details of the ‘individual’ type customer. You can do this
by invoking the relevant screens by clicking on the respective buttons.
The information that you capture in these screens forms more a part of a credit line questionnaire.
Whenever you are deciding on a credit limit for an individual customer, you can use these details
for verification.
You have to maintain the following parameters for every individual type of customer:
Prefix 1, 2 and 3
Specify the title prefixed to the name of the customer whose code is input against Customer Code
in the Main section. The title could be Mr. /Mrs./ Ms./ Dr. / Prof. etc.
2-32
The academic titles (like Prof., Dr., etc) of the customer along with the salutations (like Consulate,
Senator, Chancellor, etc.). You can either select the prefixes from the option list key-in a prefix of
your choice.
Name
First
Specify the First of the customer.
Middle
Specify the Middle name of the customer.
Last
Specify the Last name of the customer.
Second Surname
Specify the second surname of the customer.
Telephone
Specify the telephone number of the customer.
Fax
Specify the fax number of the customer.
E-mail
Specify the E-mail address of the customer.
Mobile Number
Specify the mobile number of the customer.
Communication Mode
Indicate the mode of the communication to the customer to intimate about the beneficiary account
credit. You can select one of the following options:

Mobile

Email ID
The above field is enabled only for the product that uses the NEFT clearing network, i.e., Network
Qualifier of the Clearing network should be NEFT.
2-33
Legal Guardian
Date of Birth
Specify the customer’s date of birth from the adjoining calendar.
Birth City
Specify the city name from the adjoining option list where the customer was born.
Birth State
Specify the state name from the adjoining option list where the customer was born.
Birth Country
Specify the country name from the adjoining option list where the customer was born.
Minor
Specify if the customer is major or minor from the adjoining drop-down list. If the customer’s age
is less than 18 years, then select ‘Minor’. If the customer’s age is more than 18 years, then select
‘Major’. Select ‘Emancipated Minor’ if the customer is financially independent.
Incapable
Check this box to indicate that the customer is incapable to act i.e. minor or handicapped.
Submit Age Proof
Indicate the age proof submission status of the minor to major from the drop-down list. The
available options are:

Not required

Pending

Verified
Note the following:

Any out flow or debit transaction is posted on a particular customer’s account/s and the
‘Submit Age Proof’ chosen is ‘Pending’, then the system throws an error stating that:
‘Necessary documents are not submitted for Major’

Once the documents are submitted, the user has to manually set ‘Submit Age Proof’ as
‘Verified’.

After the field ‘Submit Age Proof’ is changed to ‘Verified’, then all the accounts created for
the customer would be allowed for withdrawals.
2-34
Guardian Document ID
Specify the valid guardian document Id (NIF). The adjoining option list displays all the valid
document Ids. Select the appropriate one.
Guardian
Specify the name of the guardian.
Sex
Indicate the gender of the customer.
National ID
Specify the national identification number or national social security number of this customer.
Domicile Address
City
Specify the city of the customer. The adjoining option list displays the list of city names
maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
Province
Specify the province of the customer. The adjoining option list displays the list of province
maintained in the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
Postal Code
Specify the postal code. The adjoining option list displays the list of postal codes maintained in
the ‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. Select the appropriate one.
Country
Specify the country of the customer. A list of all country codes maintained in the ‘Country Codes
Maintenance’ screen is available in the option list. You can select the appropriate code.
Passport Details
Passport Number
Specify the passport number of this customer.
Issue Date
Specify the date on which the passport was issued.
Expiry Date
Specify the date on which the passport is due to expire.
2-35
Permanent Address
Country
Specify the permanent address country of the customer. The adjoining option list displays all the
valid country codes. Select the appropriate one.
Address Line 1 to 3
Specify the customer’s permanent address.
You may or may not choose to maintain this information for specific individuals. This is
entirely dependent on your requirement
2.2.9 Check List Tab
Click the ‘Checklist’ tab from the ‘Customer Maintenance’ screen to capture the details of
document types that are to be maintained.
If Notification Date is a holiday, then system considers first working day prior to the
Notification Date as the actual date for all calculation purposes.
On the notification date, a record is available in the Outgoing Message Browser Summary
Screen which can be retrieved by the user and the 'Prior Notification' advice can be generated
manually in the form of a letter to be sent to the customer, to inform the customer that the
document proof(s) are going to expire.
2-36
Specify the following details:
Document Type
Specify the document type. The adjoining option list displays all the document types that are
maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate one.
Along with the Proof of Residence, document 21-RFI submission is needed for a Non-resident in
an ADT Country
Name of the Document
System displays the name of the document based on the document type selected.
Reference Number
Specify the reference number for the selected document.
Issued By
Specify the name of the issuer of the document.
2-37
Date of Issuance
Specify the document issuance date from the adjoining calendar.
Note the Following:

System validates that the document is not issued before two months of the received date.

It is mandatory to specify the date of issuance for the ‘Consular Certificate’ document
type.
Expiry Date
Specify the expiry date of the document from the adjoining calendar. Date should be a future
date.
Prior Notification Days
Specify the prior notification days. Default value would be the ‘Number of days’ maintained on the
Document Maintenance Screen for the document selected. The number of days entered should be less
than the ‘differential days between Expiry Date and Current System Date’
Notification Date
Notification date gets calculated in relation with the Expiry Date of the Document and the Prior Notification
Days.
Country of Issuance
Specify the country where the document has been issued. The adjoining option list displays all
the valid country code. Select the appropriate one.
Received Date
Specify the date from the adjoining calendar on which the document is received.
It is mandatory to specify the received date for the ‘Consular Certificate’ document type.
Unique ID
Check this box to indicate that the selected document type is unique.
Compilation Date
Specify the date from the adjoining calendar on which the documents are compiled.
Approval Date
Specify the date from the adjoining calendar on which the documents are verified and approved.
2-38
Person/Organization
Specify the name of the person or organization that has approved the document.
Name
Specify the name of the document.
Comment
You can specify any other information as a comment regarding the selected document type.
Document Series
Specify the serial number for the selected document.
Checked
Check this box to indicate that the received documents are acknowledged.
Remarks 1 to 10
Specify the additional information, if required.
2.3
Customer Document Expiry Query Screen
Customer Document Expiry Query Screen performs search on the basis of the Customer
Number, Document Type, Document Expiry From Date and Document Expiry To Date. So, only
those customers, who have the specified document type and within the expiry date gets returned
as response. Also, user can search customers whose documents are getting expired in the
provided date range in the search criteria.
Document Expiry To Date specified should be greater than or equal to Document Expiry
From Date.
You can invoke the ‘Customer Document Expiry Query’ screen by typing ‘STDDOCQU’ in the
field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-39
Customer Number
Specify the customer number from the adjoining option list.
Document Type
Specify the document type from the adjoining option list.
Document Expiry From Date
Specify the document expiry from date from the adjoining calendar based on which customer document
search is to be performed.
Document Expiry To Date
Specify the document expiry to date from the adjoining calendar based on which customer document search
is to be performed.
2.3.1 Maintaining Domestic Details of Individual Customer
As part of maintaining personal details of the customer, you can capture Domestic details about
the customer like the customer’s educational status, marital status, number of dependents etc.
Click on ‘Domestic’ button. The Customer - Domestic Details screen will be displayed.
In this screen, you can capture the following details for each individual type of customer:
2-40

The Marital status of the customer: A customer could be married, single, re-married,
divorced, separated, widowed etc. You have to indicate the appropriate

The name and employment status of the customer’s spouse

The educational status of a customer (Under Graduate, Graduate, Post Graduate and
Non-student). If the customer has received no formal education, select Non-student

The family members (children and others) who are dependent on the customer
financially. You can indicate any number between 0 and 99

The type of accommodation this customer is availing of. The types could be classified
into - own accommodation, company provided and others. Others include all types other
than self-owned and company provided. You can select the appropriate option.
2.3.2 Maintaining Professional Details of Individual Customers
After having captured the Domestic details of the individual customer you can capture the
professional details about the customer.
These details include the customer’s employment status, employer details or the annual
expenses that the customer incurs and so on. Click on ‘Professional’ button. The Customer –
Professional Details screen will be displayed.
You can capture the following professional details of the individual/corporate type of customer
through this screen:
2-41
Employment
Employment Status
Specify the employment status of the customer from the adjoining option list. The options are:

Full time permanent

Full time temporary

Part-time

Self-employed

Retired pensioned

Retired non-pensioned

Unemployed
Employment Details
Tenure
Specify the number of years the customer has been in his/her current job.
Retirement Age
Specify the age at which the customer is due to retire from his/her current job or business.
Previous Destination
Specify the designation this customer held in his/her previous job or employment.
Previous Employer
Specify the name of the previous employer of this customer.
Current Designation
Specify the designation held by this customer in his present job.
Current Employer
Specify the current employer from the adjoining option list to map the current employer of the
customer.
Employer Description
You can describe the current employer’s full name here.

The name, address, country, telephone, telex, fax and E-mail address of the customer’s
current employer. The name, address and country of the employer should conform to
SWIFT standards
2-42
CNAE Code
Specify the National Activity Code. The adjoining option list displays the list of all the valid CNAE
codes maintained in the ‘CNAE/CNO Code maintenance’ screen.
It is mandatory to specify CNAE code for the individual customer except self employed.
Description
System displays the description for the selected CNAE code.
CNO Code
Specify the National Occupational Code. The adjoining option list displays the list of all the valid
CNO codes maintained in the ‘CNAE/CNO Code maintenance’ screen.
Description
System displays the description for the selected CNO code.
The ‘Current Employer’ field is used by the system to map the user to his current employer.
Click the adjoining option list to display all the authorised and open employer codes maintained in
the system.
Income
Currency of Amounts
Specify the currency in which the customer’s financial details like, annual salary, annual rent
expenses, annual loan repayment, etc is maintained.
Salary
The annual returns that your customer earns through salary and other sources of employment if
any.
Others
If your customer earns revenue through other source apart from a monthly, salary you have to
capture the customer’s combined income from all other sources.
Expense
Specify the annual expenses that your customer incurs from sources other than the annual
salary.
Rent
Specify the customer’s annual expenditure on rent.
2-43
Insurance
Specify the customers annual expenditure on premium on insurance.
Loan Payments
The customer’s current annual expenditure incurred on re-payment of loans availed.
Other
The customer’s current annual expenditure incurred on payment of expenses other than rent,
insurance premium or loans
House Value
Specify the value in terms of money, of this customer’s house (in case he owns one).
Number of Credit Cards
Specify the number of credit cards the customer has subscribed to.
Official Address
Specify the complete mailing address of the customer’s employer (Line1, Line2, Line3 &
Country).
Contact
Specify the telephone, telex, fax numbers and E-mail address of the customer’s current employer
or business partner
After having captured all the relevant details, you can save the record. You will be returned to the
Personal Details section of the CIF Maintenance screen.
2.3.3 Capturing UDF Values for Customers
In order to know your customer better, you may need to capture certain additional information
specific to a customer. This is in addition to the regular information that you would capture in the
Customer Maintenance screen. To capture more details of the customer, you can define a set of
UDFs and associate them with the function id ‘STDCIF’ (for Customer Maintenance screen). After
you associate the UDFs, they will appear in the Customer Maintenance screen. You can then
capture the values for these UDFs.
The UDFs that are displayed in the Customer Maintenance screen depend on your selections in
the ‘UDF in Base Table’ screen. A maximum of five UDFs can be made to appear in Customer
Maintenance screen.
2-44
Refer the manual on ‘User Defined Fields’ for details on defining a user-defined field and
associating the UDF with the function id ‘STDCIF’.
The values that you enter for the UDFs will be validated against the rules maintained for them. If
the entries fail the validations, the system will display a suitable message to inform you that the
entries made do not adhere to the rules maintained.
The UDFs will be displayed in the Customer Maintenance Summary screen as well. You will also
be allowed to perform queries based on these fields.
2.3.4 Special Customer Grouping
While maintaining the customer information, you can place a customer under a special customer
group for different rating purposes. Through the Special_Status user defined field (UDF) you can
link the customer to a group and specify the rating for the group.
Whenever a contract is booked for such a customer, the system will display an alert message
specifying the status of the customer thereby you can apply the new rates specified for such
customers.
The steps involved for including the SPECIAL_STATUS UDF in customer maintenance are as
follows:
1. Create a new user defined field SPECIAL_STATUS
2. Link it to the Function ID STDCIF
3. Specify the value of the user defined field at the time of creating a customer
The special status is also displayed in the information retrieval screen when you do a query for
such a customer. You can do the query using the ‘Customer Summary Query’ screen.
2-45
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘ACDCBIR’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
After having captured all the required details save the CIF record. It becomes valid only after
a user other than you authorizes it.
Check the ‘Linked Customer’ check box.
Customer Number
You can select the customer number from the adjoining option list. The available options are:

Customer Number

Document ID Number

Customer Name
Click ‘Query’ button to view all linked customers in Linked Customer Details. Select a customer
from the details and click ‘Fetch’ button to perform a query operation on the selected customer.
The displayed values are based on the query parameters provided.
2-46
2.3.5 Dictionary Details
An uploaded parameter value provided in the form of a dictionary needs to be assigned to a loan
contract in the system for the purpose of statistical reporting.
A bank need to undergo statistical reporting to ensure it is following the directives as regulated by
the central/governing bank which is the NBU. In order to abide by the regulations of the NBU and
receive approval of rules for statistical reporting, the parameter values provided by the NBU are
assigned to the customers in Oracle FLEXCUBE.
The DBF file provided by the NBU is uploaded through the ‘Upload Analytical’ screen, which is
discussed under ‘Core Services’. The customer is assigned to the parameter value
K060,K016,K150 received during customer creation.
Dictionary Name
Select the dictionary from the adjoining list for which the parameter value is to be assigned.
Field Name
Select the Field name from the adjoining List.
The adjoining option list displays all the field names in the dictionary that is selected.
Value
Select the appropriate value from the list provided after clicking ‘V’. List displays the values of the
field name.
If the wrong value is chosen or specified value is not present in LOV then an error message is
displayed.
2-47
If the D_Open date is greater than application date , then the value will not be available in the
LOV.
If D_Close date is less than the application date, then the value will not be available in the LOV.
2.3.6 Specifying Analytical Parameters
In the ‘Analytical Parameters’ tab, you can capture certain details related to the customer, which
are used for validation purposes. The values that you can capture here are uploaded from various
database tables available at the bank. Separate databases are available for the individual fields
displayed in this screen and the values that you can specify are restricted to the options available
in these tables.
For more details on upload of analytical parameters, refer the section titled ‘Uploading Analytical
Parameters’ in this user manual.
The following screen is displayed when you click ‘Analytical Parameters’ tab in ‘Customer
Maintenance’ screen.
2-48
You can capture primary and secondary parameters related to the customer, here. Once you
specify the primary parameters, the system automatically populates the values for the secondary
parameters from the corresponding linkage tables, which are also uploaded.
You can specify the following primary parameters for the customer:
Type of Economic Activity
Select the type of the economic activity the customer is involved in, from the option list provided.
The option list displays the list of values uploaded from the internal database tables available at
the bank.
Sector of Economy 1
Select the sector associated with the economic activity specified, from the option list provided.
The option list displays the list of values uploaded from the internal database tables available at
the bank.
Type of Ownership of the 1st Level
Select the ownership type of first level from the option list provided.
Section of Types of Economic Activity
Select the section related to the type of economic activity from the option list provided.
Secondary Parameters
The following secondary parameters related to the primary parameters specified are
automatically displayed here.

Type of Economic Activity

Sector of Economy 1

Sector of Economy 2

Type of Ownership of the 1st Level

Section of Types of Economic Activity
These details are picked up from the linkage tables that are uploaded to the system. You cannot
modify any of these secondary parameter values.
This is applicable only for Ukraine and if you have selected the country code of the current
branch as ‘UA’..
2.3.6.1 Validations for Customer Parameters
Validations are performed on the primary and secondary parameter values specified, by cross
checking these details with some other tables uploaded. These tables contain a combination of
values, so that the details specified in this screen are validated for correct grouping.
2-49
The following validations are carried out by the system:

For a new CIF if there are no accounts opened under the CIF, no validations are carried
out.

For a modified CIF, and accounts are already available under this, then all the
parameters of CIF and accounts should form a set and this value should be verified in the
combination database tables. Initially, the system checks if the ‘Balance Account Code’
corresponding to the customer account exists in these tables.
 If it exists then the set of both CIF and account parameters are verified in the
database table. If these parameters are not present in the tables, then an override
message is displayed.
 If the ‘Balance Account Code’ does not exist in the first table, then all the
remaining tables are searched sequentially and if not found in any of the tables, the
system displays the names of the tables where the balance account code was not
present.
 The system verifies the resident/non resident type (k030) and the balance code
against the details maintained in the system. If the value specified here does not match,
the system displays an override.
 While opening a new account, the system verifies whether the values for R020
and K030 match with the corresponding values maintained.
If there are multiple accounts for a CIF, these validations are done for each account related
to the customer.
2.3.7 Other Basic Customer Information
You will notice the following buttons in the Customer Maintenance screen:
Through this screen you can associate the customer code with a
group
Through this you can define the MIS details of a customer (for
future use)
Through this you can capture details of joint customers.
Through this screen, you can view the details of all standing
instructions associated with respective the customer code.
Through this screen, you can link different customers to the
specific customer whose details you are capturing and specify the
relation shared by the two customers.
For details about linked entities, refer to the section Maintaining
Customer Accounts under the heading ‘Relationships for
Customer’ in this user manual.
2-50
Through this screen, you can store free format text, scanned
images etc about the customer whose details you are capturing.
You can store this information either as text documents or as plain
text.
Through this you can capture user defined fields.
Through this screen, you can capture the photograph of the
customer whose details you are maintaining. You will be allowed
to access this screen, only if you have the requisite access rights
i.e., you may have rights to access the CIF screen but not view
the photograph of the customer.
Through this button you can view/modify/add (define) the liability
details of a customer, provided you have been assigned the
necessary rights.
This button appears enabled only if the function Id
LMTCURES has been added to your User Role
If this Function Id has not been added to your User Role, the
button will appear disabled.
In case of a CLS participant, you can capture CLS currency
restrictions.
Through this screen, you can specify MT920 preferences.
Through this screen, you can capture domestic details of the
customer.
Through this screen, you can capture professional details of the
customer.
In case of an issuer customer, you can capture issuer details.
Through this screen, you can view cards details of the customer.
Through this button you can call the OFAC service and view the
response from the OFAC system.
This button invokes the KYC Details screen where you can view
the KYC details of the customer.
2-51
You can capture linked account details through this screen.
Through this screen, you can maintain the joint venture details.
Using this button, you can define the dictionary details for specific
customers.
This button invokes the the MiFID classification screen to capture
the MiFID classification details for a customer.
This button invokes the Tax Details screen for specific customers.
2.3.8 Viewing Debit Card Details
Click ‘Cards’ button to view details about debit cards issued to a customer.
Here, you can view the following details.
Branch Code
The branch code is displayed from the main ‘Customer Information Maintenance’ screen.
Customer No
The customer identification code (CIF) is displayed from the main ‘Customer Information
Maintenance’ screen.
Account No
The system displays the account number against which you have maintained debit card details.
2-52
Authorisation Status
Indicate the authorisation status of the debit card by selecting one of the following values:

Authorised

Unauthorised
Record Status
Indicate the record status of the debit card by selecting one of the following values:

Open

Closed
Branch Code
The system displays the branch code where the debit card has been issued.
Request Reference Number
The system displays the request reference number of the card issuance record.
Card Number
The system displays the debit card number of the card holder.
Multiple cards can be issued to a customer.
2.3.9 Viewing OFAC Check Response
OFAC check enables the application to call an external web service to perform black list check for
customer and customer accounts and give warnings appropriately while transacting with black
listed customers. You can also capture your remarks before overriding the black list warning.
Click ‘OFAC Check’ button in ‘Customer Account Creation’ screen to view the OFAC check
response in the ‘External System Detail’ screen On clicking ’OFAC Check’ button, system will
build the request XML and call the web service. The ‘External System details’ screen displays the
response is received from the external system; and you will be also allowed to enter your remarks
in this screen. The response received will also be sent to Oracle FLEXCUBE Database layer for
any further interpretations of the same.
This button can be made visible while carrying out the actual customization. Request building
response interpretation in the database layer needs to be done as part of customization to enable
this.
2-53
Here, you can view /capture the following details:
External System Response
The response from the external system regarding the black listed customer is displayed here.
User Remarks
Specify your remarks regarding the black listed customer here.
2.3.10 Viewing KYC Details
KYC refers to know your customer. You can view the KYC details maintained for a customer on
‘KYC Maintenance’ screen. Click ‘KYC Details’ button to invoke the screen.
2-54
The system displays the following details:

KYC reference number

Full name of the customer

Type of customer

Risk level of the customer
2-55
2.3.10.1
Viewing KYC Details of Retail Customers
You can view the KYC profile details for retail customers on ‘KYC Retail Profile’ screen. Click
‘Retail Customer’ button in the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen.
The system displays the following details of the retail customer:
Beneficial Owner Information

Whether the beneficial owner is declared as a resident

Whether the beneficial owner is declared as politically exposed person

Remarks on the politically exposed person

Local address of the beneficial owner

Home country address of the beneficial owner

Birth date of the beneficial owner

Place of birth of the beneficial owner

Nationality of the beneficial owner

Telephone number of the beneficial owner’s office

Residential telephone number of the beneficial owner

Mobile phone number of the beneficial owner

Fax number of the beneficial owner

Purpose of opening the account

Other details

Type of account
2-56

Whether power of attorney is given to beneficial owner

Passport number of beneficial owner

Expiry date of the passport

Visa number of the beneficial owner

Expiry date of visa

Currency in which KYC amount is maintained
Beneficially Owned Company Details

Name of the company

Location of the company

Percentage of the holding

Annual income of the company

Line of business of the company
Source of Income
2.3.10.2

Whether salary is a source of income

Whether rental is a source of income

Whether investment is a source of income

Whether business concern is a source of income

Whether professional business is a source of income
Viewing KYC Details of Corporate Customers
‘KYC Corporate Profile’ screen gives an account of the KYC profile details for corporate
customers. Click ‘Corporate Customer’ button in the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen. The system
displays ‘KYC Corporate Profile’ screen.
2-57
The screen is as shown below:
The system displays the following details:
Customer and Sponsors Information

Name of the group

Country of Parents Company

Type of the company

Other details

Currency in which KYC amount is maintained
Reason of Account

Reason for opening an account

Other details
Specifying Nature of Business

Nature of business

Name and details of the product traded in the business

Main source of funds

Borrowing account group
2-58

Annual turnover of the company
Details of Key Person

Unique identification for the KYC

First name of the key person

Middle Name of the key person

Last Name of the key person

Relation ship of the key person with the corporate customer

Nationality of the key person

Position or title of the key person

Percentage of share for the key person

Document Id type to identify the key person

Unique document Id number of the key person
Specifying Company Details

Details of the company branches

Number of person employed in the company

Mode of salary in the company

Other details
Specifying Details of Suppliers

Name of the supplier

Country of the supplier

Mode of settlement
Specifying Details of Clients

Name of the client

Name of the country of the client

Mode of payment
Specifying Transaction Types

Type of transaction

Count of the transaction

Total amount of the transaction

Maximum single amount for the transaction

Purpose of the transaction

Country of the transaction
2-59

Purpose of fund transfer within a country

Audit date

Whether account should be solicited

Date on which the account is solicited

Details of the introducer

Date of compliance clearance

Date of business approval

Trade licence number

Next date of KYC review
Specifying Comments

KYC comment about the corporate customer

Comments on the corporate customer by the sales and service officers

Name and comments of the approvers on the corporate customers
2.3.10.3
Viewing Corporate or Audit HO Details
Click ‘Corporate or Audit HO Details’ tab in the ‘KYC Corporate Profile’ screen.
The system displays the following details:

Number of the corporate customer

Name of the corporate customer

Whether STR should be raised

Date of STR using adjoining calendar

Reference number of the STR

Whether the CB should be responded
2-60

Date of the CB Response

Details of the activity

Reason for the activity

Dairy note
2.3.10.4
Viewing KYC Details of Financial Customers
‘KYC Financial Profile’ screen displays KYC profile details for financial customer. Click ‘Corporate
Customer’ tab in the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen.
The system displays the following details:

Address of the bank

Country of the financial customer

Currency of the KYC amounts
Transaction Products

Name of the transaction product

Rating of the product

Number of monthly transactions

Monthly amount
2-61
Management Details

Name of the manager

Designation
Share Holders Details

Name of the share holder

Holding of the share holder

Address of the share holder

City of the share holder

Country of the share holder
2.3.10.5
Viewing User Defined Fields
‘User Defined Fields’ screen displays the all UDFs defined using KYC Maintenance screen. You
can invoke this screen by clicking ‘Fields’ tab in the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen.
The system displays the following details:

Name of the user defined field

Value of the user defined field
2.3.11 Maintaining Joint Venture Details
You can maintain the joint venture details for a customer on ‘Joint Venture Details’ screen. Click
‘Joint Venture’ button to invoke the screen.
2-62
The screen is as shown below:
Party ID
Specify the party ID.
Party Name
The system displays the party name.
Ratio
Specify the ratio between the participants on share.
2-63
2.3.12 Maintaining Tax Details
Click on Tax button to invoke ‘Tax Details’ screen.
You can specify the following details:
Customer No
The system displays the customer number here.
Exemption of VAT
System automatically updates ‘Exemption of VAT’. This flag is auto updated as either checked or unchecked
by the system based on the resident status of the customer and the expiry status or availability of the
documents. You can modify this flag.
Reason Code
Exemption of VAT flag when checked, the adjoining option list for Reason Code gets default
value only if one value is maintained in the limit types screen for VAT. If more than one value is
maintained in the limit types screen for VAT, system defaults with null and you need to select
from the adjoining option list. You can modify this field.
It is mandatory to specify the reason code if the tax is exempted. The system allows you to
specify the reason code only if the checkbox ‘Exemption of VAT’ is checked..
Reason
Reason gets displayed based on the reason code.
2-64
Exemption of Income Tax
System automatically updates ‘Exemption of Income Tax’. This flag is auto updated as either checked or
unchecked by the system based on the resident status of the customer, Financial Institution Type selected
and the expiry status or availability of the documents. You can modify this flag .
Reason Code
If ‘Exemption of Income Tax’ is checked, the adjoining option list for Reason Code gets default value based
on the exemption codes maintained for the specific Financial Institution Type in the Financial Institution
Exemption Maintenance screen. You can modify reason code.
It is mandatory to specify the reason code if the tax is exempted. The system allows you to
specify the reason cde only if the checkbox ‘Exemption of Income Tax’ is checked.
Reason
Reason gets displayed based on the reason code.
Exemption of Stamp Duty
System automatically updates the ‘Exemption of Stamp Duty’.This flag is auto updated as either
checked or unchecked by the system based on the Financial Institution Type selected. You can
modify this flag.
Reason Code
Reason Code gets default value based on the exemption codes maintained for the specific Financial
Institution Type in the Financial Institution Exemption Maintenance screen. You can modify Reason Code.
It is mandatory to specify the reason code if the tax is exempted. The system allows you to specify the
reason code only if the checkbox ‘Exemption of Stamp Duty’ is checked.
Reason
Reason gets displayed based on the reason code.
System displays an error message, if any of the Exemption flags are checked and the
Exemption Code is not selected
2.4
Financial Institution Exemption Maintenance Screen
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDFIEMT’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-65
You can specify the following details:
Financial Institution Code
Select Financial Institution Code from the adjoining option list. Option list displays the Financial
Institution Codes maintained in the limit types screen.
Financial Institution Name
Financial Institution Name gets displayed based on the Financial Institution code.
Stamp Duty Exemptions
Exemption
Check this checkbox if user wants to mark the Financial Institution Type as ‘Eligible for Stamp
Duty Exemption’
Exemption Code
Select the exemption code from the adjoining option list. Option list displays the exemption codes
maintained in the limit types screen.
Exemption Reason
Exemption reason gets displayed based on the Exemption Code.
Income Tax Exemptions – Residents
Exemption
Check this box if you want to indicate the Financial Institution Type as ‘Eligible for Income Tax
Exemption’ for resident customers.
2-66
Exemption Code
Select the exemption code from the adjoining option list. Option list displays the exemption codes
maintained in the limit types screen.
Exemption Reason
Exemption reason gets displayed based on the exemption code.
Income Tax Exemptions – Non-Residents
Exemption
Check this checkbox if you want to indicate the Financial Institution Type as ‘Eligible for Income
Tax Exemption’ for non-resident customers.
Exemption Code
Select the exemption code from the adjoining option list. Option list displays the exemption codes
maintained in the limit types screen.
Exemption Reason
Exemption reason gets defaulted based on the exemption code.
2.5
Financial Institution Exemption Summary Screen
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STSFIEMT’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-67
You can specify the following details:
Authorization Status
Specify the authorization status from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Authorized

Unauthorized

Rejected
Record Status
Specify the record status from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Open

Closed
Financial Institution Code
Specify the Financial Institution Code from the adjoining option list.
Financial Institution Name
Specify the Financial Institution Name from the adjoining option list.
2-68
2.5.1.1 Stamp Duty Exemption Indicator
Customer is exempted from Stamp Duty either on the basis of the Financial Institution Type associated to
the customer (Automatic Exemption) or on the basis of manual exemption.
Information regarding Stamp Duty exemption is captured in below mentioned fields:

Exemption of Stamp Duty

Reason Code

Reason
Automatic Exemption Process
Making a customer exempt from Stamp Duty on the basis of a Financial Institution Type is an
automatic process. In this process, once the bank user selects the Financial Institution Type, the
values in ‘Exemption of Stamp Duty’ and ‘Reason’ gets automatically filled on the basis of the
exemption information maintained for the selected Financial Institution Type. Value in the
exemption flags gets defaulted and can be manually changed by the user before saving.
Manual Exemption Process
You can manually check or uncheck the ‘Exemption of Stamp Duty’ checkbox and can manually
change the ‘Reason Code’ and 'Reason’.
Apart from the customer level exemptions, there are some operations on the basis of which the
bank can exempt or reduce the applicable tax. If overrides are done at the contract level and
bank wants to tax the customer at a reduced rate, then changes will be made at each of the
identified contract level screens. You can modify the rate as defaulted from the customer level on
the contract screen. The reduced rate taxing is applicable only for stamp duty tax.
2.5.1.2 VAT Exemption Indicator
A customer is exempted from VAT either on the basis of the counrtry associated to the customer
and the expiry status or availability of the documents (automatic exemption) or on the basis of
manual exemption.
Information regarding VAT exemption is captured in below mentioned fields:

Exemption of VAT

Reason Code

Reason
Business Processing
System follows the system logic which checks the Customer Country Code and the Branch
Country Code and the expiry status or availability of the documents. If the Customer Country
Code is different from the Branch Country Code, then the Customer Status is to be ‘NonResident’. Customer is considered to be a non-resident and exemption of VAT is checked if valid
documents are attached.
2-69
The ‘Exemption Code and Reason’ in the Customer Maintenance Screen gets defaulted, if it has
one value for VAT. If more than one value is maintained in for VAT, it gets defaulted with NULL
and you need to select from the list of values.
Automatic Exemption Process
If you check ‘Exemption of VAT’ check box, then system checks the Customer Country Code and
the Branch Country Code and the expiry status or availability of the documents. If the Customer
Country Code is different from the Branch Country Code, then the Customer Status is to be ‘NonResident’. Customer is considered to be a non-resident and exemption of VAT is checked if valid
documents are attached.
The Exemption code and Reason option list in the Customer Maintenance Screen gets default
value only if it has one value for VAT. If more than one value is maintained for VAT, it gets default
with NULL and you need to select from the option list.
Value in the exemption flags gets defaulted and can be manually changed by the user before
saving.
Manual ExemptionUser can manually check or uncheck the ‘Exemption of VAT’ checkbox and can manually change
the ‘Reason’ and ‘Reason Code’.
2.5.1.3 Income Tax Exemption Indicator
Customer is exempted from Income Tax either on the basis of the Financial Institution Type and
Country associated to the customer and the expiry status or availability of the documents
(automatic exemption) or on the basis of manual exemption.
Information regarding Income Tax exemption is be captured in below mentioned fields:

Exemption of Income Tax

Reason Code

Reason
Business Processing
At the time of registration of a customer on the customer maintenance screen, user selects the
Financial Institution Type and Country to which the customer belongs.
Customer is exempted from Income Tax either on the basis of the Financial Institution Type and
Country associated to the customer and the expiry status or availability of the documents.
2-70
Automatic Exemption Process
Making a customer exempt from Income Tax on the basis of a Financial Institution Type, Country
and the expiry status or availability of the document(s) is an automatic process. In this process,
once the you select the Financial Institution Type, depending on whether the customer is resident
or non-resident and depending on the expiry status or availability of the document(s) the values in
the ‘Exemption of Income Tax’ and ‘Reason’ gets automatically filled on the basis of the
exemption information maintained for the selected Financial Institution Type and Resident Status.
Value in the exemption flags gets defaulted and can be manually changed by the user before
saving.
Manual Exemption
You can manually check or uncheck the ‘Exemption of Income Tax’ checkbox and can manually
change the ‘Reason Code’ and 'Reason’.
2.5.2 Maintaining Linked Account
Click on Linked Account button to invoke ‘Linked Account’ screen.
You can specify the following details:
Verified
Check this box to verify and initiate a transaction.
Linked Account Number
Specify the Linked Account Number.
Linked Account IBAN
Specify the Linked Account IBAN.
2-71
Linked Account BIC
Specify the Linked Account BIC.
If the country code of the processing branch is Spain then Linked Account Number and
Linked Account IBAN is subjected to CCC format or IBAN account validation.
2.5.3 Maintaining MiFID Classification
Click ‘MIFD Classification’ button to invoke the ‘MIFD Classification’ screen.
You can specify the following details:
MiFID Classification
Classification
Specify the MiFID classification from the adjoining drop-down list based on the internal
assessment for the customer. Default value of this field is ‘None’. You can modify it by selecting
one of the following:

Retail

Professional

Counter Party
Note the following:

You can select ‘Professional’, ‘Retail’, or ‘None’ for the Individual or corporate customer
types only.
2-72

You can modify the classification from ‘Counter Party’ to ‘Professional’ and from
‘Professional’ to ‘Counter Party’ for the corporate type of customer only.

The MiFID classification is not allowed for the ‘Bank’ type customer.

You cannot change the MiFID classification If the initial MiFID classification is ‘Retail’.

You can select the classification to Professional / Counterparty from ‘None’.
Expiry Date
Specify the date on which the MiFID will expire from the adjoining calendar.
MiFID Classification Status
Specify the MiFID classification status from the adjoining drop-down list. You can select one of
the following:

Approved

Requested

Pending

None
Eligible Counter Party Type
Specify the eligibility counter party type. The adjoining option list displays the following options:

Investment Firms

Credit Institutions

Insurance Companies

UCITS and their Management Companies

Regulated Financial Institutions

Government Undertakings
Remarks
You can specify the reason to change the MIFD classification to another; change i=of eligibility
conditions or change of eligible counter party type.
Eligibility Conditions
You can specify the eligibility conditions by selecting one or more options below:
Heritage (Portfolio Value) more than 500000
Check this box to indicate that the heritage portfolio value is more than 500000.
2-73
Quarterly Operations > 10
Check this box to indicate that the quarterly operations are more than 10.
Financial Experience > 1Year
Check this box to indicate that the financial experience is more than 1 year.
Corporate Equity >= 2 MM.E.
Check this box to indicate that the corporate equity is more than or equal to 2 MM.E.
Corporate Liabilities of Balance >=20 MM.E.
Check this box to indicate that the corporate liabilities of balance is more than or equal to 20
MM.E.
Corporate Turnover >= 40 MM.E.
Check this box to indicate that the corporate turnover is more than or equal to 40 MM.E.
Note the following:


For ‘Individual’ type of customer with MIFD classification as ‘Professional’, you can select
any two of the following options:

Heritage (Portfolio Value) more than 5000000

Quarterly Operations > 10

Financial Experience > 1Year
For ‘Corporate’ type of customer with MIFD classification as ‘Professional’, you can select
any two of the following options:

Heritage (Portfolio Value) more than 5000000

Quarterly Operations > 10

Financial Experience > 1Year

Corporate Equity >= 2 MM.E.

Corporate Liabilities of Balance >=20 MM.E.

Corporate Turnover >= 40 MM.E.
System will not allow selecting Eligibility conditions if the MiFID Classification is ‘Counter Party’ or
‘Retail’.
2.5.4 Maintaining Employer Details
In Oracle FLEXCUBE, you can maintain details regarding the employer of a customer. You can
maintain the employer details in the ‘Employer Maintenance’ screen. You can invoke this screen
by typing ‘SMDEMPMT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking
the adjoining arrow button.
2-74
The screen is as shown below:
You can maintain the following details here:
Employer Code
Specify a unique code for the employer. The employer code can be an alphanumeric character
with a maximum length of nine characters.
Employer Description
Enter a small description for the employer code entered.
2.5.5 Maintaining Province, City and Postal Code Details
You can maintain the customer’s province, city and postal code details using ‘Province City
Maintenance’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDPRCTY’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-75
You can specify the following details:
Country
Specify the code of the country for which you want to maintain the province, city and postal
codes. The adjoining option list displays all valid country codes maintained. Select the
appropriate one.
Description
System displays the brief description about the selected country.
Province/Region Details
Province/Region Code
Specify the province/region of the selected country that you want to maintain in the system.
Province/Region Description
You can briefly describe the specified province/region.
2-76
District Details
District
Specify the district of the selected country and specified province/region that you want to maintain
in the system.
District Description
Briefly describe the specified district.
City Details
City
Specify the city name of the selected country, specified province/region and specified district that
you want to maintain in the system.
City Description
You can briefly describe the specified city.
Postal Code Details
Postal Code
Specify the postal code of the selected city that you want to maintain in the system.
2-77
2.5.6 Maintaining Province, City and Postal Code Summary Details
You can view summary details of the province/region, district, city and postal code using
‘Province City Maintenance’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STSPRCTY’ in the
field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can base your queries on any or all of the following parameters and fetch records:

Authorization Status

Record Status

Country
2.5.7 Maintaining Customer Sector Details
You can maintain the sector details for the customer using ‘Customer Sector Maintenance’
screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDCUSST’ in the field at the top right corner of
the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-78
You can specify the following details:
Sector Code
Specify the unique code to identify the sector level. The length of this code can be used to
determine till what level the sector is defined.
Sector Level 1 to 5
Specify the sector levels here.
Sector GL Node
Specify the sector GL node from the adjoining option list.
Sector Province Node
Specify the Sector Province Node from the adjoining option list.
Leaf Sector
Check this box to indicate that there is no next level sector for this sector code. This is the final
level sector.
2.5.8 Maintaining CNAE/CNO Code
You can maintain the CNAE (National Activity Code) or CNO (National Occupational Code) using
‘CNAE/CNO Code Maintenance’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDCNOCD’ in
the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-79
You can specify the following details:
CNAE/CNO Type
Specify whether you want to maintain CNAE/CNO code from the adjoining drop-down list.
Code
Specify the code for the selected CNAE/CNO type.
Description
You can describe the selected CNAE/CNO code.
2.5.9 Maintaining CNAE, Sector Code and Customer Type
You can maintain the CNAE (National Activity Code), sector code and customer type using
‘CNAE Sector Customer Type Maintenance’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing
‘STDCNSCT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the
adjoining arrow button.
2-80
You can specify the following details:
Unique Code
Specify the unique code here.
CNAE Code
Specify the CNAE (National Activity) code from the adjoining option list.
Sector Code
Specify the sector code from the adjoining option list.
Customer Type
Specify the type of customer. You can select any one of the following:

Individual

Corporate

Bank
2.5.10 Maintaining Economic Group Code
You can generate the economic group code using ‘Economic Group Code Maintenance’ screen.
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDGCMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-81
Economic Group Code
Click ‘New’ button to generate the economic group code. Four characters of bank code and
eighteen characters of sequential code compose the twenty two characters of economic group
code.
Group Description
Specify the economic group code description.
System will not allow you to close the economic group codes that are linked to the active
customers.
2.5.11 Maintaining External Bank Details
You can maintain external financial institution details (External Bank Code & External branch
code ) using the ‘External Bank Maintenance’ screen. Invoke this screen by typing ‘STDEXTBD’
in the field at the top right corner of the application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow
button.
External bank details’ maintenance is done for the Spain banks. Based on this maintenance,
system validates the external bank account during the transaction.
2-82
Bank Code
Specify the bank code.
Bank Description
Specify a brief description of the external bank here.
Branch Code
Specify the branch code of the above-mentioned external bank.
On CCC validation, the system checks if the branch code used in the account is an active
branch code.
Branch Description
Specify a brief description on the branch.
Status
Select the status from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Active – If the mentioned branch is active

Closed– If the mentioned branch is closed, the same can be activated at any time.
Effective Date
The system defaults the current application date as effective date.
2-83
2.5.12 Viewing External Bank Details
You can view the external bank details in the external bank summary screen. You can invoke this
screen by typing ‘STSEXTBD’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and
clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can base your queries on any or all of the following parameters and fetch records:

Authorization Status

Record Status

Bank Code
2.5.13 Maintaining Waiver for Customer Tax Group
You can maintain waiver related information for Customer Tax Group – Tax Category
combination. Invoke this screen by typing ‘STDTAXWV’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-84
The screen is as shown below:
Customer Group
You need to specify the Customer Group for which you wish to maintain Tax waiver. Select a
customer group from the option list provided.
Customer Number
All customers who have been maintained under the selected customer tax group will appear for
selection. If the maintenance is applicable to all customers, select ‘All’ as customer number. If no
maintenance is done, then there will be no tax waiver at the customer level.
Tax Category
You need to specify a tax category for which you wish to main tax waiver
Tax Currency
You need to specify the currency in which the tax waiver should be defined. Select ‘All,’ if you
wish to define tax waiver for all currencies
Product Or Account Class
You need to specify the Product/Account Class for which the tax waiver is being defined. All
account classes and all LD/MM products will be available for selection. You may also select ‘ALL’
in which case the tax waiver would be applicable to all products and account classes.
From Date and To Date
You need to specify the date from which the particular waiver rule is applicable. The To Date is
the date up to which the waiver rule is effective.
2-85
The To Date should be greater than or equal to the From Date. The To Date field can also be left
blank which would indicate that the maintenance is open-ended.
System updates To Date of all records having To Date NULL with new tax cycle’s start date 1 and inserts a new record with From Date as new tax cycle’s start date and To Date as NULL at
the time of tax cycle update.
Waiver %
Specify the tax waiver in terms of percentage, which should be made applicable for the period
defined. The value you enter should be > 0 and < = 100.
2.5.13.1
Pick-up Order for Waiver Rule
The following table gives the waiver rule pick up order:
Customer
Group
Customer
No
Tax
Category
Currency
Product/Account
Class
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
ALL
Specific
ALL
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
Specific
Specific
ALL
Specific
ALL
Specific
ALL
Specific
Specific
ALL
Specific
ALL
ALL
Thus for a specific customer in the group, the rule is relaxed for the product first and then for the
currency. If no rule is available for selection, then the same process will be repeated where
customer number is ‘ALL’ for the customer group.
When you select the ‘New’ option the system disables To Date and arrives at To Date based on
following conditions:
Case 1 - From Date is within current tax cycle:
While maintaining a new record, system checks if there are any record with From Date greater
than or From Date less than From Date of the record being maintained. The system performs the
following actions accordingly:
2-86

If there are no such records, system will update To Date as NULL and disables it.

If there is a record with From Date less than From Date of the record being maintained
and it is within the current tax cycle, during authorization, system updates To Date for
immediate previous record to From Date of the record being authorized -1.

If there is a record with From Date greater than From Date of the record being maintained
and it is within the current tax cycle, system defaults To Date as (From Date of the record
found – 1) and disables it when you save the record.
Case 2 - From Date is a back date and less than current tax cycle start date:
While maintaining a new record, system checks if there are any record with From Date greater
than or From Date less than From Date of the record being maintained. The system performs the
following actions accordingly:

If there are no such records, system will find out the tax cycle using From Date and
default To Date of the record with end date of the tax cycle and also inserts a record with
same limit amount for the current tax cycle.

If there is a record with From Date greater than From Date of the record being
maintained, system will default To Date (From Date of the record found – 1) and disables
it when you save the record.

If there is a record with From Date less than From Date of the record being maintained,
during authorization, system will update To Date for immediate previous record to From
Date of the record being authorized -1.

If a new record is opened with backdated From Date, the system will check if From Date
is within the current tax cycle and displays an override message if the same is not within
the current tax cycle.
For the backdated modification or a new record opened, the From Date cannot be lesser than
the current tax cycle start date. In such cases, system displays an override message if the From
Date is less than the current tax cycle start date.
2.5.14 Maintaining Tax Allowance Limit for Customers
You can maintain tax-free allowance limit at the Customer level. Invoke this screen by typing
‘STDCULMT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the
adjoining arrow button.
2-87
The screen is as shown below:
Customer Group
You need to specify the tax group of the customer for whom you wish to define tax-free allowance
limit. Select from the option list provided.
Customer Number
You need to specify the customer number for which you wish to define tax free allowance limit.
Only customers belonging to the selected tax group will be available for selection. You may also
select the ‘All’ option. This is indicative of all customers for the selected Tax Group.
Tax Category
You need to specify the tax category for which you wish to define tax free allowance limit. Select
from the option list provided.
From and To Date
You need to specify the date from which the tax-free allowance limit is effective, as well as the
date up to which this limit is applicable. The To Date should be greater than or equal to the From
Date. The To Date field can also be left blank which would indicate that the maintenance is openended.
System updates To Date of all records having To Date NULL with new tax cycle’s start date 1 and inserts a new record with From Date as new tax cycle’s start date and To Date as NULL at
the time of tax cycle update.
Limit Currency
You need to specify the currency in which the free allowance limit is being defined
2-88
Limit Amount
You need to specify the maximum waiver for the taxable amount (Basis Amount) for the customer
for each tax cycle if the End Date overlaps tax cycles or for a particular tax cycle if the period falls
within a specific tax cycle.
Remarks
You can specify any remarks you think necessary for the tax limit you have defined. This will be
in free format text.
The system disallows the ‘Close’ and ‘Re-open’ operations for the maintenance.
When you use the ‘Unlock’ option for an existing tax-free allowance limit, system checks if the
utilization for the tax cycle is more than the limit amount. It uses ‘From Date’ to get the tax cycle
and then finds out the utilization amount for that tax cycle between ‘From and To Dates’. If the
utilization amount is more than limit amount of the record, then system displays an error
message.
When you use the ‘New’ option, the system disables the date field and arrives at ‘To Date’ based
on following conditions:
Case 1 - From Date is within current tax cycle
While maintaining a new record, system checks if there is any record with From Date greater than
or less than the From Date record being maintained. The system performs the following actions
accordingly:

If there are no such records, system will update To Date as NULL and disables it.

If there is a record with From Date less than From Date of the record being maintained
and it is within the current tax cycle, then system will check the utilized amount for the
current tax cycle and compare the same with the limit amount of the record being
maintained. If the limit amount is less than the utilized amount, system displays an error
message, if limit amount is greater than or equal to utilized amount, then it allows
maintaining the record.

If the utilized amount > limit amount for immediate previous record in the same tax cycle,
then system displays an override message.

During authorization, the system updates To Date for immediate previous record to From
Date of the record being authorized -1.

If there is a record with From Date greater than From Date of the record being maintained
and it is within the current tax cycle, system will default the To Date (From Date of the
record found – 1) and disables it when you save the record. It also checks if the limit
amount is > than least limit amount for the records having From Date greater than From
Date of the record being maintained for the same tax cycle. If yes, system displays an
error message.
2-89
Case 2 - From Date is a back date and less than current tax cycle start date
While maintaining a new record, system checks if there is any record with From Date greater than
or From Date less than the From Date of the record being maintained. The system performs the
following actions accordingly:

If there are no such records, system finds out the tax cycle using From Date and default
To Date of the record with end date of the tax cycle and inserts a record with same limit
amount for the current tax cycle.

If there is a record with From Date greater than From Date of the record being
maintained, system will default To Date as (From Date of the record found – 1) and
disables it when you save the record. It also checks if the limit amount is > than least limit
amount for the records having From Date greater than From Date of the record being
maintained for the same tax cycle. If yes, system displays an error message.

If there is a record with From Date less than From Date of the record being maintained,
system will check the utilized amount for the tax cycle and compare the same with the
limit amount of the record being maintained. If limit amount is less than utilized amount,
system will display error message. If limit amount is greater than or equal to utilized
amount, system will allow maintaining the record.

If the utilized amount > limit amount for immediate previous record in the same tax cycle,
then the system displays an override message.

During authorization, system updates To Date for immediate previous record to From
Date of the record being authorized -1.

If a new record is opened with backdated From Date, system will check if From Date is
within the current tax cycle and displays an override message if the same is not within the
current tax cycle.
Note the following:

From date cannot be back dated

When a new record is created, system will check if already a church tax declaration
record is present for the same customer with To Date as null. If such a previous record is
present, previous record’s to date will be updated as the new record’s from date – 1.

From date of the current record getting created should be greater than the end date of
latest previous record (if available) for the same customer

Church tax declaration record will be allowed for amendment. Only the end date will be
allowed to be updated. End date can be updated only if the current value of end date is
blank.

For the backdated modification or a new record opened, the From Date cannot be lesser
than the current year Start date. In such cases, system displays an override message if
the From Date is less than the current year start date.
2-90
Example
Assume the following:
 Current Tax Cycle - TAXCY2
 Start date - 01/04/2010
 End date - 30/06/2010,
 Previous Tax Cycle - TAXCY1
 Start Date - 01/01/2010
 End Date - 31/03/2010
Case 1: From Date within the Current Cycle
 New Record
 From Date - 01/06/2010
 Limit Amount - 1500 USD
From Date Less than the New From Date
Existing Record
 From Date - 01/04/2010
 Limit amount - 3000 USD
 Utilized Amount(TAXCY2) - 2000 USD
Since Limit Amount < Utilized Amount i.e. 1500USD < 2000 USD, system displays an error message.
Existing Record
 From Date - 01/04/2010
 Limit amount - 3000 USD
 Utilized Amount(TAXCY2) - 1000 USD
Since Limit Amount > Utilized Amount i.e., 1500USD > 1000 USD, system creates a new record and
updates the To Date of the previous record to 31/05/2010.
From Date Greater than the New From Date
Existing Record
 From Date - 15/06/2010

Limit amount - 2000 USD
Since New Limit Amount < existing least Limit Amount i.e., 1500 USD < 2000 USD, system creates a new
record and defaults the To Date as ‘From Date’ of existing record -1 i.e., 14/06/2010.
2-91
Existing Record


From Date - 15/06/2010
Limit amount - 1000 USD
Since the New Limit Amount > Least Limit Amount i.e., 1500 USD > 1000 USD, system displays error
message.
If there is no record maintained greater than or less than 01/06/2010, system creates new record and
defaults the ‘To Date’ as null.
Case 2: From Date backdated and less than the Current cycle Start Date
New Record
 From Date - 01/03/2010
 Limit Amount - 1500 USD
From Date Less than the New From Date
Existing Record
 From Date - 15/02/2010
 Limit Amount - 3000 USD
 Utilized Amount(TAXCY1) - 2000 USD
Since Limit Amount < Utilized Amount i.e., 1500USD < 2000 USD, system displays an error message.
Existing Record
 From Date - 15/02/2010
 Limit amount - 1000 USD
 Utilized Amount(TAXCY1) - 1500 USD
Since Limit Amount >= Utilized Amount i.e. 1500USD >= 1500 USD, system displays an override message
and allow to create a record. It also updates the To Date of the previous record with 28/02/2010.
From Date Greater than New From Date
Existing Record
 From Date - 10/03/2010
 Limit amount - 2000 USD
Since New Limit Amount < existing Least Limit Amount i.e., 1500 USD < 2000 USD, system creates a new
record and defaults the To Date as ‘From Date’ of existing record -1 i.e., 09/03/2010.
2-92
Existing Record
 From Date - 10/03/2010
 Limit amount - 1000 USD
Since the New Limit Amount > Least Limit Amount i.e., 1500 USD > 1000 USD, system displays an error
message.
If there is no record maintained greater than or less than 01/03/2010, system creates a new record and
defaults the ‘To Date’ as 31/03/2010.
2.5.14.1
Deriving Tax Free Allowance Limit
The following table will be used to derive the tax-free allowance limit:
Customer Tax Group
Tax Category
Customer No
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
2.5.15 Maintaining Church Tax Declaration for a Customer
You can maintain the church tax for a customer in the ‘Church Tax Declaration’ screen. You can
invoke this screen by typing ‘STDCHTAX’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The screen is given below:
2-93
In this screen you can maintain the following details:
Customer Number
Specify the customer number for which the church tax has to be collected. Alternatively, you can
also select the customer code from the adjoining option list.
Church Tax Start Date
Specify the date from which the church tax for a customer is applicable. Alternatively, you can
also select the date from the calendar button.
When you create a new record, the system will check if a church tax declaration is already
present for the same customer with To Date as null. If such a previous record is present, the
previous record’s To Date will be updated as the new record’s From Date - 1.From date of the
current record getting created should be greater than the end date of latest previous record (if
available) for the same customer.
Church Tax End Date
Specify the date till when the church tax declaration is applicable. The Effective to date can also
be left blank which indicates that the maintenance is open-ended.
2.5.15.1
Processing Church Tax
An SDE basis, ‘Church tax’ is used to derive the church tax percentage applicable for a customer.
This SDE is used in the IC rule to calculate and apply the church tax.
For more details on SDEs, refer to ‘Maintaining System Data Elements’ section in the Interests
and Charges User Manual.
An IC calculation is forced when one of the following happens:
When the customer’s location is changed
When a new church tax declaration is created / existing church tax declaration modified for a
customer
When IC calculation happens during EOD, system will first find out if there is a valid church tax
declaration record for the current liquidation cycle. If there no such record, system will prepare a
single SDE base record with date as liquidation cycle start date and basis amount as 0.
If church tax declaration record is present, SDE base records will be prepared based on the
church tax declaration start date, end date and the church tax percentage maintained for the
customer’s location.
Change of customer’s location within a liquidation cycle will not be tracked. Only the latest
location of the customer in a liquidation cycle will be considered for the whole liquidation cycle
The following example illustrates how SDE base records are formed:
2-94
Example
Assume that the liquidation cycle is from 01-Jan-2008 to 31-Mar-2008.
Scenario 1
rd
Church tax declaration record has Effective from date as 3 Feb, 2008, with no Effective to date. The church
tax percentage maintained for the customer’s location is 8%.
In this scenario, the SDE record base is formed as follows:
Basis Date
Basis Figure
01-Jan-2008
0
03-Feb-2008
8
Scenario 2
th
On 15 Feb, 2008, the customer’s location is changed and the tax percentage for the changed location is
9%.
th
During 15 Feb, 2008 EOD, the SDE record base is formed as follows:
Basis Date
Basis Figure
01-Jan-2008
0
03-Feb-2008
9
Scenario 3
th
On 14 March, 2008, customer gives a declaration to end the church tax. In this case, the ‘Effective to date’
th
in the ‘Church tax declaration’ screen will be updated as 14 March, 2008.
th
During 14 March, 2008 EOD, the SDE base record is formed as follows:
Basis Date
Basis Figure
01-Jan-2008
0
03-Feb-2008
9
14-Mar-2008
0
Scenario 4
st
th
Liquidation cycle becomes 1 Apr, 2008 to 30 June, 2008.
Customer does not give any further new church tax declaration. In this case, for this liquidation
cycle, no church tax will be applied. The SDE base record is formed as follows:
Basis Date
Basis Figure
2-95
01-Apr-2008
2.5.15.2
0
Viewing Church Tax Declaration Details
You can view the details maintained for church tax declaration in the ‘Church Tax Declaration
Summary’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STSCHTAX’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The screen in given below:
2.5.16 Amendment Maintenance
To recall, you need to identify the fields that can be amended by an external system, say, a
Siebel CRM application.
Every amendment request coming from such a system has the following data:

Service Name: – This is a broad level grouping of similar operations within a module in
Oracle FLEXCUBE. The service names are published by Oracle FLEXCUBE. As an
example, you can consider FCUBSCustomerAccountService. This service is exposed by
the FCUBS Interface Gateway to do a permissible operation on a customer account.
2-96

Operation Name:- This is the name of the operation that the external system wishes to
perform within the service. These operations names are published by Oracle
FLEXCUBE. As an example, you can consider ModifyCustomer, which is for modification
of a customer.

External Operation Name:- This is the specific area of operation that an external system
is performing on its side within the broad context of the Oracle FLEXCUBE’s amendment.
In an external system, if the personal details of a customer are changed, this has a
unique name by which it is identified within Oracle FLEXCUBE. Similarly, if the limits
related details of a customer are modified, it also has a unique name.
It is through the ‘Amendment Maintenance’ screen that you maintain a set of amendable fields,
which can amend in Oracle FLEXCUBE whenever a request for the same will be send from an
external system. Based on this maintenance, the amendment request is addressed by Oracle
FLEXCUBE. Invoke this screen by typing ‘STDAMDMT’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The screen is as shown below:
External System
Select the relevant external system. Based on the maintenance here, only the fields that are
selected as amendable can be modified if a request comes from the chosen external system.
The maintenance pertaining to external systems is factory shipped for your bank.
2-97
Source Operation
The free format text (without spaces) which identifies the amendment you are doing. This is
mandatory
Service Name
The relevant service name, this is a broad level grouping of similar operations within a module in
Oracle FLEXCUBE. The service names are published by Oracle FLEXCUBE.
The maintenance pertaining to service names is factory shipped for your bank
Operation Code
The relevant operation code. This is the operation that the external system wishes to perform
within the selected service. The operation names are published by Oracle FLEXCUBE. As an
example, you can take ‘Modify Customer’, which is for modification of a customer record. Each
operation under different service names is identified by a unique code.
The maintenance pertaining to operation codes is factory shipped for your bank.
Element Name
The relevant field, that can be amended.
On choosing a field, its type gets defaulted in the ‘Element Type’ field. It can be one of the
following:
Element - These ultimate leaf elements occur directly under the parent node of an amendment
request. It is displayed as an ‘F’.
Node - This is a child node of a main amendment request. It has its own child elements and
nodes. It is displayed as an ‘N’.
2.5.16.1
Processing for Element
If such a field is sent as part of an amendment request and is maintained in this screen, then a
value for that field is expected when the request comes in from the external system. In case no
value is passed, Oracle FLEXCUBE updates the field to a null value. If any value is passed, the
same is taken as the new value for that field.
2.5.16.2
Processing for Node
If the field selected is of type ‘Node’, a check box called ‘Full Amend’ gets enabled. This pertains
to only the ‘Node’ type elements and not for the ‘Element’ type. Checking against ‘Full Amend’
indicates that the external system always has to send the complete set of records for the
subsystem whether amendment of that node is done or not. By default, the ‘Full Amend’ field is
unchecked.
2-98
In case ‘Full Amend’ is checked, system overwrites the details during amendment even if all field
values pertaining to a particular subsystem are not sent. In such a scenario, Oracle FLEXCUBE
updates the fields with the available data sent by the external system during an amendment. If no
records are passed for a subsystem during amendment, the complete subsystem is set to a
NULL value.
In case the flag ‘Full Amend’ is not checked, system copies the details from the previous version
and then makes changes to the existing records based on values sent by the external system. If
any new record comes as part of an amendment record, the system inserts the same. If the
upload table is empty during amendment, the system retains the data of the previous version.
The following points are noteworthy within the context of any amendment maintenance:

Only subsystems of a contract or maintenance qualify for being a ‘Node’ type. The
master record is never included as part of a ‘Node’ type and its fields alone are labeled
as ‘Elements’.

This maintenance is required for supporting amendment requests from any external
system. If no maintenance is done for a particular external system and source operation,
the amendment fails.

The list of fields (available in the LOV) that can be amended for a particular Service and
Operation combination is factory shipped for your bank. You can add or remove fields
based on your requirement.
To delete an element from the list of amendable fields, you can use Delete icon. To add an
element to the same, you can use the Add icon.
2.5.17 Specifying Details for Generation of MT920
The SWIFT message MT920 is a transaction message requesting latest information available for
the particular account. The request will be to transmit account customer statement message
(MT940) or Balance report (MT941) or Interim statement (MT942) or a customer summary
statement (MT950).
Check the MT920 checkbox only if the customer is eligible for requesting MT920 swift messages
for transaction details. In the Customer Maintenance screen, you can indicate if a customer is
eligible for requesting MT920 messages. To do this, you need to click MT920 button in the
‘Customer Information Maintenance’ screen and invoke the ‘MT920’ screen.
2-99
The screen is shown below:
Here you can enter the following details:
BIC Code
Enter or select valid BIC from the option list. This BIC Code information provided by you is
crucial.
Account Number
Once you specify the BIC code, you can enter the relevant Account Number adjacent to it. Click
‘Ok’ to save the details entered here.
2.5.17.1
Defining Customer Category
You may wish to classify the customers of your bank into certain broad categories/groups. For
instance, all financial institutions who are your bank’s customer can be classified into a single
common group head called Financial Institutions. Similarly, you can have a category called
banks, individuals, etc.
The classification of customers into categories can be used for retrieving financial information by
customer category; for generating reports on queries; and restricting access of a customer to a
product in the front - end modules, for instance, Funds Transfer, Data Entry, etc. You may also
retrieve financial information by customer category.
The categories are maintained in the ‘Customer Categories’ screen and are maintained at the
bank level by your Head Office. The customers are allocated different categories maintained in
this screen in the ‘Customer Information Maintenance’ screen.
2.5.18 Invoking Customer Category Screen
To invoke the ‘Customer Category Maintenance’ screen, type ‘STDCSCAT’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
2-100
The screen is shown below:
In this screen, you maintain the following:

Name of the customer category

Category ID

Description of the category

Customer log

Sub Category

Description of the Sub Category
2.5.19 Creating Customer Categories
To create customer categories the following parameters need to be maintained:
Customer Category
In this category, you can classify customers of your bank.
When you are creating a product  be it in a loan, a deposit, a placement, a swap foreign
exchange deal, or a funds transfer, you may want to restrict access to the product to a set of
customers.
2-101
For this, the customers are classified into broad categories, the code of which is input against this
field. A category consists of a group of like customers. For instance, if you create a category
called, Financial Institutions - all financial institutions who are customers of your bank will come
under this category. Likewise, all customers of your bank belong to some category.
It should be noted that at the product level, specifications made for a customer overrides the
specifications made for the category. For example, if all financial institutions are allowed access
to a particular product; you have the option of restricting the access of one or a few individual
financial institutions to his product.
Input the customer category you want to create using not more than 10 characters, alphanumeric.
The category code should be unique. For Example, for Financial Institutions category, you can
input the code as FinIn.
Description
This is the description of the customer category input above. Enter the description of the
customer category input above in not more than 35 character, alphanumeric. Taking the above
example, you can enter financial institutions
Category ID
Specify the category ID in not more than 3 numeric characters.
This is a unique identifier for each customer category. If you specify a Category ID that is already
assigned to another customer category, then, on save the system displays the following error
message:
‘Category ID already used’
The SDE, ‘CUST_CATEGORY’, displays the customer category. You can also use this SDE
for IC product maintenance.
Maintain Customer Log
Check this box to indicate that customer information has to be tracked.
Sub Category
Select the sub category for the category Id maintained, from the adjoining option list. This list
contains all the valid subcategories maintained in the system as follows. Choose the appropriate
one.

Individual Persons

Private Entrepreneurs

Private Notaries and Lawyers

Legal Entities

Banks
2-102

Legal Entities (Temporary Register)

Legal Entities (For Statutory Fund Formation)

Individuals Not Customers

Private Entrepreneurs Not Customers

Legal Entities Not Customers

Banks-Counterparties

Others
If the category you want to map is not available in the defined list, use ‘Others’ to map it.
The customer unique identifier validation is done on the basis of following parameters:

The sub category

The Identification Code

The option selected for 'Resident/Non-Resident’.
The B3 certificate number will have to be captured as the unique identifier in Documents tab.
Description
Enter the description of the customer sub category input above.
After you have made the inputs, click the Save icon to save your record. A record is not used until
a user other than you authorizes it.
To authorize, click ‘Authorize’ button in the toolbar. If any modifications were made, the old and
the new values will be displayed. After which an alert box will indicate that the change will be
authorized. You will be prompted to conform. To confirm, click ‘OK’ button. The change will be
authorized. Your User ID, the date and time at which the authorization was made will be
displayed in the Auth ID and date and time fields at the bottom of the screen. The status of the
record will be updated to ‘Authorized’. If you do not want to authorize the change then click Exit
icon, you will be returned to the screen from where you invoked the authorization function.
Remember that you cannot authorize an event that you have input. Only another user who has
the requisite rights can authorize the event.
To exit, click Exit icon. You will return to the Application Browser.
2.5.20 Maintaining Customer Groups
To track your credit exposure to a group of customers you should:

Create Customer Groups and assign credit limits to it

Associate a customer with a group
2-103
2.5.21 Maintaining Limits for Customer Group
You can maintain Customer Groups and set up credit limits in the ‘Customer Group Maintenance’
screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDGROUP’ in the field at the top right corner of
the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Group ID
You can assign a unique identification code to each customer group that you create. You can
also enter the detailed name of the group. In the subsequent fields you can set up credit limits for
the group.
While setting up a customer, you can indicate the group to which the customer is associated.
It is important to note that in Oracle FLEXCUBE a customer group is different from a
customer category. You create customer groups only to set up group limits and report credit
utilization by the customers that belong to the group.
Limit Amount and Limit Currency
The limit amount indicates the maximum amount that customers under a group can utilize. You
can indicate the currency in which the limit amount is expressed.
The outstanding of all customers associated with a group is aggregated to arrive at the credit
utilization of the group. This includes issuer risk arising out of securities issued by your customers
and held by the bank.
2.5.22 Associating Customer Account with Group
While maintaining details of a customer account, you can associate it with a customer group. A
customer can be associated with several customer groups. Click ‘Group’ button from the
‘Customer Maintenance’ screen to associate the account with a customer group.
2-104
The screen is shown below:
2.5.22.1
Specifying Group Details
To associate a customer account with a group, select Group ID from the option list. The option list
will contain a list of all the customer groups that you maintained in the ‘Customer Group
Maintenance’ screen. To add a group to the list, click Add icon and select a Group ID from the
option list. To remove a group from the list, highlight the Group ID and click Delete icon.
For each group that you associate with a customer, you can specify the relationship that the
customer shares with the group.
2.5.22.2
Specifying Shareholding Details
You can maintain percentages of shareholding of your individual customers in a corporate entity,
which is also your customer. When maintaining customer details of the corporate entity, you can
capture names and shareholding percentages of your individual customers who hold shares in
the corporate entity.
When you query in Oracle FLEXCUBE, for limits utilizations for any such individual customer,
your exposure to the corporate entities is also displayed.
Example
Silas Marner and Keith Butler are individual customers and they have contracts and accounts with your
bank. Parivallal Express Limited, Gem Granites Limited and Assorted Chemicals Limited are your corporate
customers.
2-105
Silas Marner has a shareholding in Parivallal Express Limited and Gem Granites Limited. Keith Butler has a
shareholding in Gem Granites Limited and Assorted Chemicals Limited.
While querying limits for Silas Marner, your exposure to Parivallal Express Limited and Gem Granites
Limited is displayed along with your exposure to Silas Marner.
You can choose to drill down any of the exposures to see the specific line details and contracts. However, if
you query for exposure to Parivallal Express Limited or Gem Granites Limited your exposure to Silas Marner
is not displayed.
Click ‘Ok’ button to save the details that you specified. Click the windows Close icon to exit the
screen without saving the entries that you made.
2.5.23 Maintaining Type of Relationships
You can maintain the different types of relationships that can exist between customers of your
bank in the ‘Relation Maintenance’ screen. Invoke this screen by typing ‘CSDRELMN’ in the field
at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Specify the following details in this screen:

Relation – Define the type of relationship in this field. You can use a maximum of 20
alphanumeric characters to define a relationship

Category – Select the category from the drop down list to define the nature of the
relationship with the customer. The available options are:


Customer to Customer

Customer to Account

Customer to Contract
Description – Provide a brief description of the relationship being maintained. This will
further help you in identifying the relationship. You can enter a maximum of 35
alphanumeric characters in this field.
The types of relationships defined in this screen will become available for linking two customers,
only upon authorization of the details maintained.
2-106
2.5.24 Relationships for Customers
A customer of your bank can have relationships with any other customer of your bank. Also, a
customer of your bank could be a joint account holder with another customer of your bank. You
can capture these details when you set up the CIF or customer account.
For linking a customer account, you need to specify details of the relationship for the account.
Click the ‘Linked Entities’ button in the ‘Customer Maintenance’ (CIF) screen. The ‘Linked
Entities’ screen is displayed.
You must specify a customer code, provide a description, and ID for the relationship.
Customer
Select the customer code from the option list. You can link any number of customers to the
primary holder (the customer for whom you are capturing the CIF details) through this screen by
establishing a relationship between the two customers.
Description
In this field, the system displays the name of customer that you have selected in the previous
field. You cannot change this description.
Relationship
You have to choose a relationship code to establish a relationship between the customer being
selected and the customer (primary holder) you are maintaining.
By default, the system will select the customer of the account as the Primary Holder. This is a
pre-shipped relationship and you will not be allowed to change the relationship.
2-107
Include Relationship
When you specify the relationship of the customer you can also choose to default the same
preference to the customer account maintenance for the specified customer by checking the
‘Include Relationship’ box.
Also, specifying this option at the customer maintenance level will inherit all the properties of the
customer relationship to the counterparty of the loan/deposit during the contract input.
2.5.25 Maintaining Risk Category for Customers
In order to support risk-weighted risk tracking, you will have to maintain risk details for
Customers.
You can maintain different Risk Categories for Customers in the ‘Risk Category Maintenance’
screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDRKMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of
the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Specify the following details in this screen:

Risk Category – Define the type of Risk Category in this field

Description – Provide a brief description of the Risk Category being maintained
The types of Risk Categories defined in this screen will be available for Liability maintenance of
customers and Risk percent maintenance, only upon authorization of the details maintained.
Risk Category is not a mandatory input during Customer Maintenance. Risk Category is
applicable to the Customer and not to the Customer’s Liability ID.
2-108
2.6
Maintaining Cheque Not Allowed Customer Details
You can upload the file that contains the list of customers who are not eligible for writing cheques
in the ‘Cheque Not Allowed Customer Upload’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing
‘STDCQCIF’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining
arrow button.
Specify the following:
File Name
Specify the file name that contains the list of customers who are not eligible for writing cheques.
You should input the file name along with the full file path.
The file consists of the following details, delimited by a semi-colon:

Customer ID

Effective Start Date

Effective End Date
The date is in the following format:
DD-MON-YYYY
The system validates to ensure that the start date is less than or equal to the end date as well as
the start date is less than or equal to the branch date.
When you click ‘Upload’ button, the Effective Start Date, Effective End Date and Cheque Allowed
status is updated for the customer in the ‘Customer Maintenance’ screen. If the start date is less
than or equal to the branch date for any unused cheques, including certified cheques, the status
is updated to ‘Cancelled’.
2-109
2.7
Multiple Relationships
The credit facility granted to any customer is tracked against the Liability Number of the customer.
You can also track the liability of a customer (child) against a different customer (parent). Thus,
the liability number emphasizes only one kind of relationship, that of the parent with the child.
However, a customer of your bank can have relationships with other customers of your bank i.e.
there is a possibility of one to many relationships between customers.
Oracle FLEXCUBE allows you to define different types of relationships that can exist between two
customers. For eg: Business, Husband, Wife, and Partners etc. You can link two customers by
specifying the relationship that exists between them. The advantage being that, when you
generate the exposure report for a customer, it will display the total exposure of the bank to every
customer linked to the liability in question as well as the exposure of every customer who is
related to any customer within the liability. The example given at the end of this section will further
illustrate this concept.
2.7.1 Maintaining Types of Relationships
You can maintain the different types of relationships that can exist between customers of your
bank in the ‘Relation Maintenance’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDRELMT’ in
the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Specify the following details in this screen:

Relation – Define the type of relationship in this field. You can use a maximum of 20
alphanumeric characters to define a relationship

Description – Provide a brief description of the relationship being maintained. This will
further help you in identifying the relationship
The types of relationships defined in this screen will become available for linking two customers,
only upon authorization of the details maintained
2.7.2 Maintaining Relationships between Customers
The ‘Customer Linkage Maintenance’ screen is used to maintain relationships between
customers. In this screen, you can link two customers and specify the relationship that exists
between them. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDCUREL’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-110
The screen is as shown below:
Customer 1 and 2
You can select the names of the customers between whom a relationship is to be established. All
authorized customers of your bank will be available in the option-lists provided.
Relation
Specify the type of relationship that exists between the selected customers (1 & 2). All authorized
relation types maintained through the ‘Relation Maintenance’ screen will be available in the option
list provided. You can select the appropriate name from this list.
This linkage of customers will be used for taking exposure report for the customer. If you maintain
a linkage between Customer1 and Customer2, the system will automatically establish a linkage of
Customer2 with Customer1. After you maintain a linkage between two customers, you are not
allowed to change the customers involved in the linkage. However, you can alter the relationship
that exists between them. Only one type of relationship can exist between any two customers.
The following example will illustrate the manner in which you can maintain relationship details
between customers and the need for the same.
Example
John Doe is customer of you bank. He is running a business named ‘John Doe Building Contractors’. He is
married to Jane Doe but is separated. He now lives with Mary Bloggs. In addition, he also has a partnership
with Jack Black and another partnership with Joe Green. In order to establish a relationship between the
above individuals, you have to maintain each individual as a customer in Oracle FLEXCUBE.
In the Customer Information Maintenance screen, set up the details for:

John Doe

John Doe Building Contractor

Jane Doe

Mary Bloggs

Jack Black Builders

Joe Green Builders
Since you can link loans to a single customer only, the following pairs should also be maintained as
customers:
2-111

John and Jane Doe

John Doe and Mary Bloggs

John Doe and Jack Black, Builders

John Doe and Joe Green, Builders
The linkage between the above individuals will be as follows:
Customer 1
Customer 2
John Doe
John Doe Building Contractor
John Doe
John and Jane Doe
Jane Doe
John and Jane Doe
John Doe
John Doe and Mary Bloggs
Mary Bloggs
John Doe and Mary Bloggs
John Doe
John Doe and Jack Black, Builders
Jack Black, Builders
John Doe and Jack Black, Builders
John doe
John Doe and Joe Green, Builders
Joe Green, Builders
John Doe and Joe Green, Builders
Depending on the type of loan availed and the ‘Customer’ involved in it, the exposure report will display the
accounts of the individuals as depicted in the table below:
Customer
Account
John
Doe OR
John
Doe
Builder
John Doe
Personal
Car Loan
Y
John Doe
Building
Contractor
Commercial
Loan
Current
Account
Equipment
Lease
Y
Y
Y
John and
Jane Doe
Home Loan
Y
John Doe
and Mary
Bloggs
Home Loan
Y
Jane
Doe
Jack
Black
Mary
Bloggs
Y
Y
2-112
Joe
Green
Customer
Account
John
Doe OR
John
Doe
Builder
John Doe
and Jack
Black,
Builders
Commercial
Loan
Y
John Doe
and Joe
Green,
Builders
Current
Account
Commercial
Loan
Bridging
Loan
Y
Jane Doe
Car Loan
Mary
Bloggs
Current
Account
Term Loan
Jack Black
– Builder
Current
Account
Commercial
Loan
Joe Green,
Builders
Current
Account
Jane
Doe
Jack
Black
Mary
Bloggs
Joe
Green
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
2.7.3 Maintaining Customer Groups
You can maintain customer groups for any of the following reasons:

Tracking Exposure for loans as well as outstanding overdrafts in accounts of customers
involving the group; in which case, it would comprise of either Corporate or Retail
customers.

Defining Group specific rules – in which case it would either be a Clearing or a Charge
Group. Clearing Groups are built in order to derive the Value Date of outward clearing
check transactions. Charge Groups are created in order to levy specific charges on
customers belonging to the group.
2-113
You can set up such groups through the ‘Group Code Maintenance’ screen. Invoke this screen by
typing ‘STDGRMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the
adjoining arrow button.
Group Type
You could use this section to indicate whether the customer group you are defining is:

Corporate

Retail

Charge

Clearing

Tax
You can select the appropriate option.
Creating Customer Groups for Tracking Exposure
You may wish to track exposure due to loans issued to a group of customers as a whole, and
assign the status of all loans issued to the group as the status of the loan with the worst status,
among those issued to the group.
You may similarly wish to include the exposure due to outstanding overdraft in respect of a group
of customer accounts as a whole, and assign the status of all customer accounts belonging to the
group as the status of the customer account with the worst status among the accounts and loans
belonging to the group.
When you set up a group for tracking exposure due to loans and customer accounts, you will
need to specify the applicable exposure category.
The exposure category for a group is either derived from the logic maintained in the Exposure
Type Category Linkage maintenance for the group type, or explicitly specified. If it is derived, it is
displayed in this screen, by the End of Day batch program. The type of the group indicates the
type of customers that belong to the group – retail or corporate. If no logic has been maintained
in the Exposure Type Category Linkage for the group type, you can indicate the applicable
exposure category for the group.
2-114
Group Status
All loans and overdraft accounts issued to customers in the group will be assigned the same
status, which will be the status of the loan / overdraft account with the worst status among those
issued to customers in the group. The Group/CIF and the loan contracts and overdraft accounts
are all updated with this worst status if they have been marked for automatic status processing
.The individual status for the accounts and loan contracts (apart from assigning the worst status)
is also captured and displayed. In the ‘Group Code Maintenance’ screen and the ‘CIF
Maintenance’ screen, the status for the group is displayed, as well as the date since which the
status came into effect.
For details about loan status processing and provisioning, consult the Loans user manual.
Customer Group
When you maintain CIF details for customers, in the ‘Customer Information Maintenance’ screen,
you can specify the customer group to which the customer belongs, for:

Provisioning and status processing (Group Code). You must specify a group code
defined for a group type that is the same as the customer type, for instance, if the
customer is a retail customer, you must specify a group defined for retail customers

Classifying the customer as a Clearing customer

Categorizing the customer for levying charges at a customer group level

Classifying the customer as a taxpayer. If you select this option, the Exposure Category
field will be disabled
2.7.4 Capturing Customer Prefixes
While maintaining the CIF details, of an Individual customer you can capture the academic titles
(like Prof., Dr., etc) of the customer along with the salutations (like Consulate, Senator,
Chancellor, etc.)
Therefore, you must maintain the list of possible options for each of these academic titles and
salutations referred to as ‘prefixes’ through the ‘Customer Prefix Maintenance’ screen.
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDCUSPR’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
2-115
The screen is as shown below:
The following details need to be captured:

Branch code - This is the code of the branch for which the list of prefixes will be made
available. The description associated with the branch is displayed in the adjacent field

Prefix1 - This is the first prefix to appear in the Customer Name

Prefix2 - This is the second prefix to appear in the Customer Name

Prefix3 - This is the third prefix to appear in the Customer Name
While specifying the prefix in the customer in the CIF screen, a list of all the values maintained in
this screen is displayed. You will also be allowed to key-in a prefix of your choice.
These details will be printed along with the receiver name in all messages sent to the customer. If
the global tags for prefixes have been maintained in the advice, the System substitutes the tags
with the respective prefixes maintained in the customer personal details of the receiver.
This feature is applicable only for individual customers where the media type is Mail.
2.7.5 Storing Authorized Variations of Customer’s Name
In Oracle FLEXCUBE, you can indicate whether incoming Funds Transfers, Payments and
Collections should be processed only after the customer’s Account Number and Name
correspond to the authorized variations of the customer’s name. If you have enabled this as a
preference in the ‘FT Product Preference’, and ‘PC Product Category’ screens, you will need to
maintain the authorized customer name variations through the ‘Customer Names’ screen.
2-116
Invoke this screen by typing ‘STDCIFNM’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
In this screen, you have to capture valid customer names, which have to be associated with
Customer Numbers maintained in Oracle FLEXCUBE.
Because of this maintenance, each time an incoming FT or PC contact is processed, the System
validates the account number and name involved in the transaction with the authorized customer
name. If the validation is successful, the customer name is added to the existing list and the
contract is marked as authorized.
If the validation fails the contract is marked as unauthorized. Even during manual authorization of
such contracts, an override is displayed asking whether the customer name needs to be added to
the existing list. It will be added to the existing list on confirming the override.
2.7.6 Maintaining Float Days for Outward Clearing Customer Transactions
Float days applicable for arriving at the Credit Value Date for outward clearing customer
transactions are defined through the ‘Float Days Detailed’ screen.
2-117
Invoke this screen by typing ‘STDFLTDS’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can define the float days for transactions involving a specific Clearing Bank, Branch, Product,
Sector and Currency combination for:

All customer groups and all customers within the groups

A specific customer group and all customers within the group

A specific customer group and a specific customer within the group
The System resolves the float days in the following order:
Branch
Code
Product
Code
Sector
Code
Currency
Customer
Group
Customer
Number
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
Specific
Specific
Specific
Specific
ALL
ALL
2-118
The float days will be considered as Working Days or Calendar Days depending on your
specification in the ‘ARC Maintenance’ screen.
2.7.7 Location Maintenance
In Oracle FLEXCUBE, you have a provision wherein you can maintain location codes. You do this
through the ‘Account Address Location Maintenance’ screen. Invoke this screen by typing
‘STDACLOC’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the
adjoining arrow button.
Location
The relevant location code. This pertains to a particular area in a country. It cannot be more than
15 characters
Description
A short description to the location code
Default
If the location code is to be maintained as a default location code, the same could be specified
here by checking against this option. Only one location can be marked as a default location.
The following points are noteworthy:

Once you save the above maintenance, Oracle FLEXCUBE checks for duplicate location
codes. To recall, existing location codes are maintained through the ‘Location Codes
Maintenance’ screen. If a match is found, system throws up an error.

This maintenance is applicable only for account level address maintenances and not for
address maintenances done at the customer level
2.7.8 Specifying the Dictionary Details
An uploaded parameter value provided in the form of a dictionary needs to be assigned to a
customer ID (CIF) in the system for statistical reporting.
2-119
A bank need to undergo statistical reporting to ensure it is following the directives as regulated by
the central/governing bank which is the NBU. In order to abide by the regulations of the NBU and
receive approval of rules for statistical reporting, the parameter values provided by the NBU are
assigned to the customer ID (CIF) in Oracle FLEXCUBE.
The DBF file provided by the NBU is uploaded through the ‘Upload Analytical’ screen. You can
invoke this screen by typing ‘CVDUPLAN’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
For details on ‘Upload Analytical’ screen, refer to the section ‘Uploading Analytical Parameter
Details’ in this chapter.
Click on the ‘Dictionary’ button to invoke the ‘Dictionary Details’ Screen.
2-120
Dictionary
Specify the name of the dictionary. The option list displays all valid dictionaries maintained in the
‘Dictionary Maintenance’ screen.
Field Name
Select the name of the field assigned the parameter value from the uploaded dictionary. The
option list displays all valid fields available for the dictionary selected in the above field.
If D_OPEN (dictionary open) is greater than the current system date for any record in the
dictionary value then such a record of the dictionary will not be available in the option list. If the
(dictionary close) D_CLOSE is smaller than the current system date for any record in the
dictionary value then such record of the dictionary will not be available in the option list.
Value
Specify the value of the parameter to be assigned to the Oracle FLEXCUBE customer
contract/account. You can also populate this value by clicking on the button ‘V’. You can change
the value of the parameter.
Click ‘V’ button and select the appropriate value from the list provided.
If the value specified is not present in system then the system displays the error ‘Value mismatch
in the dictionary’.
If a wrong value is chosen or specified for a particular field from the option list then an error
message is displayed.
2.8
Maintaining KYC Type
Oracle FLEXCUBE maintains KYC details for all customers. For Individuals / Salaried employees,
the KYC is fairly simple and straight forward. However, for Small and Medium Enterprises (SME)
and corporate customers or Banks, the KYC for the company and its Directors should be done.
The KYC for any share holder having the percentage of stock equal to or more than the defined
percentage should be done. These share holders may not be the banks customers. The System
maintains KYC for NON-CIF customers also.
Oracle FLEXCUBE tracks all the sources of funds/income of any person/company/banks
undergoing KYC. The system also tracks approximate number of transactions they are expected
to perform in their accounts.
2-121
You can specify the details of KYC type in the ‘KYC Type Maintenance’ screen. You can also
invoke this screen by typing ‘STDKYCTP’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Here you can specify the following details:
KYC Type
Specify the type of KYC that should be maintained.
KYC Type Description
Specify the description that should be maintained for the specified KYC type.
2.8.1 Specifying KYC Value Details
You can specify the following KYC value details:
KYC Type Value
Specify the value of the KYC type.
KYC Type Value Description
Specify the description for the KYC type value.
2-122
The table below illustrates the KYC types and the possible values for each KYC types.
KYC Type
Possible Values
KYC_DECLARED
Ownership
Shareholding
KYC_SRC_INCOME
Salary
Rental
Investment
Business Concerns
Professional Business
Overseas Property
Others
KYC_TYP_COMP
Sole Proprietor
Partnership
LLC
PSC
PJSC
Free Zone Enterprise
Government Entity
Charity Orgn
FZ Co.
Offshore Company
FZ LLC
Others
KYC_PURPOSE
Commercial
Individual
KYC_DET_PURPOSE_COMM
Commercial Banking
Trade Services
2-123
KYC Type
Possible Values
Private Banking
Investments
Loans
Retail Banking
Null (Provide Details)
KYC_DET_PURPOSE_IND
Salary Transfer
Savings
Investment
Loan Repayment
Transactional
KYC_SAL_TYPE
Cash
Direct Deposit
Company Cheque
TT/SWIFT/CB
Null (Provide Details)
KYC_SETTL_PAY
Cash
Cheque
Wire Transfer
LC/Documentary Collection
KYC_TXN_DET
Monthly Withdrawals
Deposits
Remittances By Cash
Remittances BY Cheque
Local Remittance (Inward)
Local Remittance (Outward)
Foreign Remittance (Inward)
2-124
KYC Type
Possible Values
Foreign Remittance (Outward)
For Salaried Individuals, this is required only for
Risk level 2 & 3 customers
KYC_TYPE_ACC
Sole/Joint
KYC_OCCUPATION
Own Business
Employed
KYC_FI_STATUS
Ho
Branch
Central Office
Subsidiary
Rep Office
Others
KYC_FI_TYPE
Commercial Bank
Investment Bank
Offshore Bank
Leasing Company
Exchange Company
Others
KYC_AREA_OF_BUSINESS
Retail
Corporate
Investment
Transfers
Islamic Banking
Trade
Treasury
Others
2-125
KYC Type
Possible Values
KYC_OWNERSHIP
Government
Private Owned
Public Held
Partly Owned By Gov and part by private or public
Investors/Partly Traded in Stock Exchange
Shares Traded In Stock Exchange & Partly Held
By Private And Public Investors
Others
KYC_PRODUCTS
Incoming Transfer – MT103
Incoming Transfer – MT202
Outgoing Transfer – MT103
Outgoing Tranfer – MT202
Clearing and Collections (Cheques and Drafts)
LC Advising
LC Reimbursements
LC Confirmation
LG Advising
Bill Discounting
Bankers Acceptances
Risk Participation (Funded and Non-funded) per
annum
KYC_BANK_STRUCTURE
Board of Directors
Executive Committees
KYC RATING
Satisfactory
Unsatisfactory
Fair
KYC SHARE HOLDER TYPE
Legal Entity
2-126
KYC Type
Possible Values
Individual
2.9
Maintaining Customer KYC Details
You can maintain the KYC details of the customer in the ‘KYC Details’ screen. You can invoke
this screen by typing ‘STDKYCMN’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar
and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Here you can specify the following details:
KYC Reference Number
The system displays the reference number. The KYC reference number will be generated and
displayed while saving this screen.
Full Name of Customer
Specify the full name of the customer.
KYC Customer Type
Specify the type of KYC customer from the adjoining drop-down list. The list displays the following
values:

Retail Customer

Corporate Customer

Financial Customer
Risk Level
Select the risk level from the drop-down list. The list displays the following values:

Level1

Level2

Level3
2-127
Retail Customer Tab
You can specify the KYC profile details for retail customer in the ‘KYC Retail Profile’ screen. Click
‘Retail Customer’ tab to invoke this screen.
You can capture the following details on this screen:
Beneficial Owner Information
You can specify the following details pertaining to the beneficial owner:
Resident
Check this box to indicate that the beneficial owner is a resident. If you do not check this option,
the system will not consider the owner as a resident.
Politically Exposed Person
Check this box to indicate that the beneficial owner is a politically exposed person.
PEP Remarks
Specify the remarks about the declaration of the beneficial owner as politically exposed person.
Local Address
Specify the local address of the beneficial owner.
Home Country Address
Specify the home country address of the beneficial owner.
2-128
Birth Date
Specify the birth date of the beneficial owner.
Birth Place
Specify the place of birth of the beneficial owner.
Nationality
Specify the nationality of the beneficial owner.
Office Tel Number
Specify the telephone number of the beneficial owner’s office.
Residence Tel No
Specify the residential telephone number of the beneficial owner.
Mobile Tel Number
Specify the mobile telephone number of the beneficial owner.
Fax
Specify the Fax number of the beneficial owner.
Purpose of Account Opening
Specify the purpose of opening the account.
Others
If you wish to provide any additional information about the beneficial owner, use this field.
Account Type
Specify the type of the account.
Power of Attorney
Check this box to indicate that the beneficial owner holds a power of attorney.
Passport Number
Specify the passport number of beneficial owner.
Passport Expiry Date
Specify the expiry date of the passport.
2-129
Visa Number
Specify the visa number of the beneficial owner.
Visa Expiry Date
Specify the expiry date of visa.
KYC Amounts Ccy
Specify the currency in which KYC amount is maintained.
Beneficially Owned Company Details
You can specify the details of the beneficially owned company in the following fields:
Company Name
Specify the name of the company.
Location
Specify the location of the company.
% Holding
Specify the percentage of holding.
Annual Income
Specify the annual income of the company.
Line of Business
Specify the line of business of the company.
Source of Income
You can specify various sources of income in the following fields:
Salary
Check this box to indicate that salary is a source of income.
Rental
Check this box to indicate that rent is a source of income.
Investment
Check this box to indicate that investment is a source of income.
2-130
Business concern
Check this box to indicate that the business concern is a source of income.
Professional Business
Check this box to indicate that the professional business is a source of income.
2.9.1.1 Corporate Customer Tab
You can specify the KYC profile details for corporate customer in the ‘KYC Corporate Profile’
screen. You can invoke this screen by clicking ‘Corporate Customer’ tab in the ‘KYC
Maintenance’ screen.
Here you can specify the following details:
Customer and Sponsors Information
You can specify the information of customers and sponsors in the following fields:
2-131
Groups Name
Specify the name of the group.
Parent Company’s Country of Inc
Specify the country of Parents Company. The adjoining option list displays all valid countries
maintained in the system.
Type of Company
Specify the type of the company. The adjoining option list displays all valid company types
maintained in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Others
If you wish to provide additional information on customer and sponsors, use this field.
KYC Amounts Ccy
Specify the currency in which KYC amount is maintained.
Reason of Account
You can specify the reasons for opening the account in the following fields:
Purpose of Account Opening
Specify the reason for opening an account. The adjoining option list maintains all valid reasons
maintained in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Others
If you wish to provide additional information and reasons, use this field.
Nature of Business
You can specify the nature of business in the following fields:
Nature of Business
Specify the nature of business. The adjoining option list displays all valid businesses maintained
in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Product Traded
Specify the name and details of the product traded during the course of the business.
Main Source of Funds
Specify the main source of funds.
2-132
Borrowing Account Group
Specify the borrowing account group.
Annual Turnover
Specify the annual turnover of the company.
Details of Key Person
You can specify the details of the key person in the following fields:
KYC ID
Specify a unique identification for the KYC details of the key person.
Name
Specify the name of the key person.
Relationship
Specify the relationship between the key person and the corporate customer. The adjoining
option list displays all valid relationships maintained in the system. You can choose the
appropriate one.
Nationality
Specify the nationality of the key person. The adjoining option list displays all valid nationalities
maintained in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Position or Title
Specify the position or title of the key person.
Share Percentage
Specify the percentage of share for the key person.
Company Details
You can specify the details of the company in the following fields:
Details of Company Branches
Specify the details of the company branches.
Number of Person Employed
Specify the number of person employed in the company.
2-133
Mode for Salary
Specify the mode of salary payment in the company. The adjoining option list displays all valid
modes maintained in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Others
If you wish to provide additional information on the company, use this field.
Details of Suppliers
You can specify the details of suppliers in the following fields:
Supplier Name
Specify the name of the supplier.
Country
Specify the country to which the supplier belongs.
Settlement Mode
Specify the mode of settlement. The adjoining option list displays all valid modes maintained in
the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Details of Clients
You can specify the client’s details in the following fields:
Client Name
Specify the name of the client.
Country
Specify the name of the country of the client.
Payment Mode
Specify the mode of payment. The adjoining option list displays all valid modes maintained in the
system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Transaction Types
You can specify the details of the transaction types in the following fields:
Transaction Type
Specify the type of transaction.
2-134
Count
Specify the count of the transaction.
Total Amount
Specify the total amount of the transaction.
Max Single Amount
Specify the maximum single amount allowed for the transaction.
Purpose
Specify the purpose of the transaction,
Country
Specify the country in which the transaction takes place.
Fund Transfer Purpose within Country
Specify the purpose of funds transfer within the country.
Audit Date
Specify the audit date. Use the date button to choose a date from the calendar.
Account Solicited
Check this box to indicate that the account should be solicited.
Account Solicited Date
Specify the date on which the account should be solicited using adjoining calendar button.
Introducer Details
Specify the details of the introducer.
Compliance Clearance
Specify the date of compliance clearance using adjoining calendar.
Business Approval
Specify the date of business approval using adjoining calendar.
Trade Licence No
Specify the trade licence number. The adjoining option list displays all valid licence numbers
maintained in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
2-135
KYC Next Review Date
Specify the next date of KYC review.
Comments
KYC
Specify the comments on the KYC details of the corporate customer.
Sales and Service Officer
Specify the comments of sales and service officer on the corporate customer.
Approvers
Specify the name and comments of the approvers of the corporate customers.
2.9.1.2 Corporate or Audit HO Details Tab
Click ‘Corporate or Audit HO Details’ tab in the ‘KYC Corporate Profile’ screen.
Here you can specify the following details:
CID Number
Specify the CID number of the corporate customer.
Name
Specify the name of the corporate customer.
STR Raised
Check this box to indicate that the STR should be raised.
2-136
STR Date
Specify the date of STR using adjoining calendar button.
STR Reference Number
Specify the reference number of the STR.
CB Response
Check this box to indicate that the CB should be responded.
CB Response Date
Specify the date of CB Response using the adjoining calendar button.
Activity
Specify the details of the activity.
Activity Reason
Specify the reason for the activity.
Dairy Note
Specify the dairy note.
2.9.1.3 Financial Customer Tab
You can specify the KYC details of financial customers using the ‘KYC Financial Profile’ screen.
You can invoke this screen by clicking ‘Corporate Customer’ tab in the ‘KYC Maintenance’
screen.
2-137
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can specify the following details:
Bank Address
Specify the address of the bank.
Country
Specify the country of the financial customer.
KYC Amounts CCY
Specify the currency of the KYC amounts.
Specifying Transaction Products
Specify the following details:
Transaction Products
Specify the name of the transaction product.
Rating
Specify the rating of the product.
2-138
Monthly No of Transactions
Specify the number of monthly transactions.
Monthly Amount
Specify the monthly amount.
Specifying Management Details
Specify the following details:
Name
Specify the name of the manager.
Designation
Specify the designation of the manager.
Specifying Share Holders Details
Specify the following details:
Name
Specify the name of the share holder.
Holding
Specify the holdings of the share holder.
Address
Specify the address of the share holder.
City
Specify the city of the share holder.
Country
Specify the country of the share holder.
2-139
2.9.1.4 Fields Tab
You can create user defined fields using the ‘User Defined Fields’ screen. To invoke this screen,
click ‘Fields’ tab in the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen.
Here you can specify the following details:
Field Name
Specify the name of the field.
Value
Specify the value of the field.
2.10 Creating a Message Advice Format
You need to create a message advice format through the ‘Advice Format Maintenance’ screen
with the format named ‘CUS_MIMJADV’. A batch function ‘CASABAT’ will perform status change
from Minor to Major during EOD.
During EOD, batch (CASABAT) which would check for the current age of each minor customer, if
the customer’s current age is on or above the minor age limit maintained at branch parameters
then you to do the following mentioned settings:

The option ‘Minor’ at customer personal details will be unchecked in customer
maintenance screen.

The select ‘Submit Age Proof’ as ‘Pending’ in customer maintenance screen.
Note the following:

In case of holiday the Minor to Major conversion would be done after the holiday.
2-140

The Debit would be still allowed for the system initiated transactions (During EOD/BOD)
even though the documents have not been submitted.
Customer Advice generation:
During EOD, batch (CASABAT) will generate the advice for the customers who are going to attain
the Major status based on the number of days mentioned at Branch Parameters level for advice
generation.
The customer will receive an advice in the following sample format:
#RH
< Customer Minor Major Advice>
----------------------------------Date
: _BRANCHDATE_
Bank Name
: _BANK-NAME_
Branch Address
: _BRANCH-ADDR_
Customer Name
: _CUST-NAME1_
Customer ID
: _CUSTOMER_
You are attaining the Major status on _DATE_ .Hence please submit the necessary
documents on or before _DATE_.
#EH
#B
#SC
AUTHORIZED SIGNATORY.
#EC
#EB
2-141
2.11 Viewing Customer Details
You can view the details of the customers of your bank in the ‘Customer Summary’ screen. To
invoke the screen, type ‘STSCIF’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and
click on the adjoining arrow button. The following screen is displayed:
In this screen, you can query based on any combination of the following fields:

Authorization Status

Customer No

Name

Customer Category

Nationality

Document ID Number

Record Status

Type

Short name

Country
2-142

Branch Code

Tax Id
After specifying the parameters for the query, click ‘Search’. The system displays all the records
matching the parameters specified.

Authorization Status

Record Status

Customer No

Type

Name

Short Name

Customer Category

Country

Nationality

Branch Code

Language

Address

Frozen

Deceased

Exposure

Location

SSN

Whereabouts Unknown

Account Number

Swift Code

Value

Document ID Type

Document ID Number

Tax ID
2-143
3. Maintaining Mandatory Information
3.1
Introduction
As part of capturing customer related information in Oracle FLEXCUBE you need to maintain
Customer Information Files (CIF records) for each entity who is a customer of your bank. Apart
from creating CIF records for each entity you need to maintain separate accounts for each
customer. The features of these two screens have been discussed in detail in the preceding
sections.
While defining CIF records and Customer Accounts, you would have noticed that many of the
fields have option lists positioned next to them. While some option lists contain pre-defined values
for some option lists to be populated you need to capture data through separate screens. For
instance, while maintaining CIF records you need to associate each customer with a customer
category. For this purpose you will need to maintain customer categories before you begin to
maintain CIF records. Similarly, each customer account needs to be associated with an account
class. Therefore, you will need to maintain account classes before you start defining customer
accounts.
All such screens have been documented in the subsequent sections
3.2
Maintaining Account Classes
In the Oracle FLEXCUBE system, you can classify the customer accounts of your bank into
different groups and assign each an identifying code. For instance, you may define a group called
INDSB to represent savings accounts held by individuals, SB-INS to comprise institutional
savings accounts, COR-CU for corporate current accounts.
Each group is referred to as an Account Class and is maintained in the ‘Account Class’ screen.
For each class, you also define certain common attributes applicable to all accounts in this class,
such as, the General Ledger lines to which the accounts in this class report to, facilities granted to
the account holders (pass book, check book, ATM etc.).
In the ‘Customer Accounts Maintenance’ screen, where you open accounts for the customers of
your bank, each customer account is linked to an account class, and the attributes defined for the
account class are by default applicable to the customer account. For instance, if the frequency of
account statement generation has been defined as daily for an account class CU-COR, the
system generates statements for all accounts under this class on a daily basis. However, some of
the parameters defined for the account class, can be revised at the account level for any of the
accounts linked to the class. Account level parameters will supersede those defined for the
account class.
While defining the account classes you should also keep in mind that the interest rate structure is
also specified for an account class (in the Interest and Charges module).
The account class table is maintained at the Bank Level by the Head Office branch.
3-1
3.2.1 Invoking Account Class Maintenance Screen
You can invoke the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen by typing ‘STDACCLS’ in the field at the
top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Defining an Account Class includes the maintenance of the following parameters:
1. Assigning a unique Code to the Account Class and associating an appropriate description
with the class
2. Indicating the type of account for which account class is being maintained
3. Specifying the period after which accounts in this class should become dormant if no
customer transaction is posted into the account.
4. Indicating the date from when new accounts can be created under the account class.
5. Indicating the end date after which the new accounts cannot be created for the account class.
6. Maintaining the different statuses applicable to the accounts for which the account class is
being defined. This would be used for tracking NPA’s on current and savings accounts.
7. Maintaining status-wise GLs for provisioning
8. Identifying the reporting lines (GL Line, Central Bank Lines and the Head Office Lines) for
each status.
3-2
9. Maintaining account statement details like the type of statement that is to be generated, the
frequency at which statements should be generated for all accounts under a class.
10. Indicating the preferences unique to an account class like the check book, passbook or ATM
facilities to be given to account holders under this account class; whether overdraft facility
should be allowed for accounts linked to this class; whether the credit limit should be checked
for all accounts under the class; interest and charges to be computed for accounts under this
class.
11. Specifying preferences regarding account holder facilities, interest computation etc.
12. Indicating whether status change for all accounts belonging to the account class should be
automatic or manual.
13. Identifying and assigning preferred branches, currencies and customers to the account class.
14. Specifying whether receivables should be tracked for the account class. This specification will
default to all accounts that are linked to this account class.
15. Specifying whether reordering of Cheque Books for all accounts linked to this account class
should be triggered automatically or not. If yes, the parameters for the same.
16. Specifying liquidation preferences for debit interest and charges, to notify your customers
through a Debit Interest Notification message (in the case of charges, a Charge Notification
message) before debiting the customer’s personal current account for debit interest or
charges.
17. Maintaining initial funding details for new accounts
18. Indicating whether Escrow transfer is applicable or not for new accounts
Each of the parameters has been discussed in detail in the subsequent sections
Account Class and Description
The account class code is a unique 6-character code, which identifies the class. Along with the
class code you need to assign an appropriate description to the account class.
For instance, let us assume you are defining a class for savings account of individuals. You could
associate the code SB IND with it. Similarly, the description that you associate with it could be
something like this – ‘Savings accounts of individuals’.
Account Type
The six different types of accounts that you can maintain are:

Nostro account - your bank’s accounts with another bank
3-3

Miscellaneous Debit - Each transaction is entered with a reference number. In the
miscellaneous debit account a single debit transaction is matched subsequently with
credits against the same reference number.
While posting transactions into this account, if the first entry is a debit, the subsequent reconciling
entries should be all credits.
The system gives you a break-up of the balance by the reference number
Example
Let us assume that for the month of November 2000, your bank has to spend USD 10,000 on miscellaneous
expenses, which include canteen charges, telephone bills and other maintenance charges. When the details
of these expenses are entered, the following entries are passed:
I entry
Dr. Misc. debit a/c for 10,000
Cr. Cash a/c for 10,000
I reconciling entry Dr. expense a/c for 3000 (canteen charges)
Cr. Misc. Debit a/c for 3000
II reconciling entry
Dr. expense a/c for 2000 (telephone charges)
Cr. Misc. Debit a/c for 2000
III reconciling entry
Dr. expense a/c for 5000 (maintenance)
Cr. Misc. debit a/c for 5000
Thus the entire amount that was debited from miscellaneous debit account has been reconciled. The total
amount of the reconciliation entries should add up to match the amount of the first transaction.

Miscellaneous Credit - as in miscellaneous debit account, in the miscellaneous credit
accounts you post each transaction with a reference number. In a miscellaneous credit
account a single credit entry is matched subsequently with debit entries with the same
reference number.
The system gives you a break-up of the balance by reference numbers

Savings Account

Current Account
Line Account - This is used for creating accounts for charging limit fees. Upon save of the
account class with type as line account, there will be an override specifying that the reporting
GL’s for the accounts should be contingent GLs. There will not be any accounting entries passed
into the accounts of line account type. This will only be used as the calculation account for
calculating the limit fees. Hence, the account balance of this account will always remain as 0.
To ensure the line account functionality, you will have to maintain the following:
3-4
In the ‘Customer Account Maintenance’ screen, you will have to create new customer accounts
with Account Class type as Line Account and ensure the following parameters for every new line
associated with a liability

The CIF of the account in the ‘Customer Account Maintenance’ screen will have to be the
same as the liability to which the line will be linked in the ‘Limits’ screen.

The currency of the account in the ‘Customer Account Maintenance’ screen will have to
be the same as the currency of the line that will be attached in the ‘Limits’ screen.

The interest calculation account maintained in the ‘Interest and Special Conditions
Maintenance’ screen, will have to be the same as in the ‘Limits’ screen. However, the
Interest Booking Account maintained in the ‘Interest and Special Conditions Maintenance’
screen can be some other account belonging to other account class types.
Since accounts can be of different types, you need to indicate the type of account for which you
are defining an account class. It could belong to any one of the types mentioned above
Account Code
As per your bank’s requirement you can choose to classify account classes into different account
codes. The bank can decide the manner in which the account classes are to be assigned to
different account codes. An account code can consist of a maximum of four characters.
Depending on the customer account mask maintained, the value in the account code field would
be used during the generation of customer account numbers through the ‘Customer Accounts
Maintenance’ screen.
If you have decided to include account code as part of the customer account number (in the
account number mask), then at the time of creating a new customer account number, you will
need to select the account class for the account number being generated. In the option-list
provided, the account class is displayed along with the associated account code. When the
account number gets populated, it is the account code that forms a part of the customer account
number.
Start Date
Specify the date from which the account class should become active, using the adjoining
calendar. You will be able to create accounts under this account class from this date.
End Date
You can also specify the life span of the account class by indicating the end date.
The end date for an account class refers to the termination date after which, creation of new
account under the account class is disallowed.
Consequently, the option list for Account Class in all further transactions screen in Oracle
FLEXCUBE, will not display the ‘expired’ account class as of the system date. However, the
existing accounts for the account class will be active even after the end date.
3-5
If you do not specify an End Date for the account class, the account is taken to be an openended account class.
Project Account
Check this box to track the working capital of the project.
Dormancy Days
You have to indicate the period after which an account in an account class becomes inactive or
dormant if customer transactions are not posted into the account.
However, while maintaining transaction codes, if you have checked the Consider for Account
Activity field, all transactions posted to any account under this account class linked to the
particular transaction code will become active from dormant irrespective of the dormancy period.
If a customer-initiated transaction is posted into the account with the dormant status the account
status will be updated to Active from Dormant since the Transaction Code associated with the
account has the Consider for Account Activity option enabled.
Dormancy Parameters
As stated above, if Transaction Code associated with the account has the Consider for Account
Activity option enabled, the dormant status of the account will be updated to Active. Apart from
this, you can specify the parameter that is required for re activating the account. To indicate the
re activation parameters for the dormant account choose any from the following options:

Debit

Credit

Any

Manual
In case of a transaction, the system will check for the parameter you have specified here and
accordingly change the status of the account. However, the parameter maintained at the account
level will super cede the parameter you have specified here.
Account Statement Format
Specify the format in which account statement should be generated. The adjoining option list
displays all valid formats maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate one.
Display IBAN in Advices
For an account class you can indicate whether the IBAN number of the customers involving the
accounts within the class should be printed on advices sent to the customer. If you would like to
print the IBAN number of the customers on advices sent to the customers involving the account
class, you can enable the Display IBAN in Advices option by checking it.
Specify the value other than ‘None’ for the fields ,inorder to check for IBAN availability for
accounts belonging to particular class and printing it in the advices and statements.
3-6
Your specification will be made applicable to all customers linked to the account class. You will be
allowed to change this option for a specific account.
IBAN Account numbers for specific customers can be captured while defining a specific
account through the IBAN Sub-screen of the ‘Customer Account Maintenance’ screen.
Display Nib in Statements and Advices
For an account class, you can indicate whether the NIB number of the customers involving the
accounts within the class should be printed on advices sent to the customer or not.
Specify the value other than ‘None’ for the field ,inorder to check for NIB availability for accounts
belonging to particular class and printing it in the advices and statements.
Note the following:

IBAN is displayed in blocks of four characters.( PT50 0002 0123 1234 5678 9015 4)

NIB is displayed in blocks of four characters prefixed with ‘NIB’ (NIB 0002 0123 1234
5678 9015 4)
Dual Ccy Deposit
Check this box to enable the account class for Dual Currency Deposit (DCD) type.
Dual Currency Deposit (DCD) is a short-term currency-linked deposit that allows you to earn a
higher interest rate than regular time deposits.
You will be allowed to check this field only for ‘Deposit’ Account Type. If this box is checked
for other Account types, system throws an error.
Natural GL
The reporting of all turnovers of the particular account class will be directed to the GL that you
identify as the natural GL. Based on the characteristic of the account balance; you can specify
whether the turnover is to be posted to the Debit GL or to the Credit GL. For instance, if the
account class is for overdrafts, the balance is normally a debit whereas current accounts normally
do not have a debit balance.
Applicable Customer Status
Specify the applicable customer status from the drop-down list. The available options are:

Major

Minor

Both

Not Applicable
3-7
Note the following:

By default ‘Not applicable’ option would be selected when a new account class is
created.

If you select ‘Minor’ option at the CIF level and ‘Applicable customer status’ as ‘Major’ at
the account class level then the system throws an error stating that:
The A/c class you selected is for major customer

Similarly if you uncheck ‘Minor’ option at the CIF level and select ‘Applicable customer
status’ as ‘Minor’ at the account class level then the system throws an error stating that:
The A/c class you selected is for minor customer
3.2.2 Statement Parameters Tab
For each account class that you maintain you have the option of generating account statement
details, periodically, for all customer accounts associated with the account class.
If you need to generate account statements that would need to be sent across multiple media,
generated at different frequencies, you can define up to three different frequencies at which the
statements could be generated, with a primary, secondary and tertiary frequency.
Click ‘Statement Parameters’ tab to invoke the screen for maintaining these details. The screen is
displayed below:
As part of specifying the account statement preferences you can indicate the following for each of
the statements, whether primary, secondary or tertiary:
3-8
Type
The first preference that you specify for each account class is to indicate whether the periodic
generation an account statement is required. If the generation of an account statement is
necessary, you have to specify the format in which it is to be generated. The options available
are:

Detailed – indicating that the statement should be a detailed account of all the customer
transactions within the account class.

Summary - indicating that only a summary of the transaction details is enough.

None – indicating that neither a summary nor a detailed account of transactions is
required.
Cycle
The system generates the account statement details at a frequency that you specify. The
frequency can be:

Annual

Semi-annual

Quarterly

Monthly

Fortnightly

Weekly

Daily
If you indicate that the statement generation frequency is weekly, you should also indicate the
day of the week on which the account statement is due. Similarly, for a monthly statement you
should indicate the day of the month.
To specify the frequency for a monthly statement you can specify a number between 1 and 31
(corresponding to the system date). If you set the statement date to 30, then account statements
will be generated on:

The last working day for months with < 30 days.

For months with 30 days on the 30th; if 30th is a holiday on the next working day.
If you set the statement date to 31, then account statements will be generated on:

The 31st, for month with 31 days; if 31st is a holiday on the next working day.

The last working day for months < 31 days.
For all other cycles, account statement would be generated on the last day of that cycle.
3-9
Offline Limit
This is the limiting amount till which transactions will be carried out between account(s) for the
account class you are defining here, between branches when the database connectivity is not
functional.
Enter the off-line limit here.
Note the following:

If you are defining primary, secondary and tertiary statements, the frequency for each
must be different and unique; for instance, if you define a monthly primary statement, you
cannot define a secondary or tertiary statement with a monthly frequency.

Offline limit is maintained only for primary level.
CSB 43 Statement
Type
Select the CSB Statement type from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Type (1)

Type (2)

Type (3)

The system displays an error message if Type 3 is selected.
Cycle
Select the CSB 43 Statement cycle from the adjoining drop down list. The options are:

Semi Annual

Quarterly

Monthly

Fortnightly

Weekly

Daily

Annually
CSB 43 Statement Generation batch (STBCSBGN) is configured to generate CSB 43 account
statement.
Document Check List
Specify the following details:
3-10
Document Type
Specify the document type. The adjoining option list displays all the document types that are
maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate one.
Customer Type
Specify the customer type. The adjoining option list displays all the customer types that are
maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate one.
Mandatory
Check this box to indicate that the document specified here is mandatory.
3.2.3 Maintaining Cheque Book Preferences
Oracle FLEXCUBE provides you with the facility to automatically trigger the reorder of Cheque
Books for all accounts reporting to a specific account class. However, you have the option of
changing your preferences at the account level also.
To facilitate automatic reordering of Cheque Books, you have to maintain the following details:
Cheque Book
To indicate that automatic reordering of cheque books should be allowed and for specifying the
details for the same, you have to check this option. If not selected, you will not be able to maintain
the automatic reordering preferences for the account class.
Auto Reorder of Cheque Book
You have to select this option to specify that automatic reordering of Cheque Books is required
for all accounts reporting to this account class. This field will be enabled only if you have checked
the ‘Cheque Book’ option explained above.
Reorder Level
Here, you have to indicate the level at which the reordering of Cheque Book should happen.
Automatic reordering will be set off by the system when the unused number of cheque leaves
becomes equal to or less than the re-order level that you maintain here. This field will be enabled
only if you have indicated that automatic reordering of Cheque Books is required i.e. the ‘Auto
Reorder of Cheque Book’ option is checked.
Reorder No of Leaves
In this field you have to specify the number of leaves that should be ordered for the new Cheque
Book. This field will be enabled only if you have checked the ‘Auto Reorder of Cheque Book’
option.
Max No. of Cheque Rejections
Specify the maximum number of cheque rejections that can be allowed for an account.
3-11
3.2.3.1 Processing Automatic Reordering of Cheque Books
The automatic reordering of Cheque Books is processed at EOD by executing a batch function.
The following conditions should be satisfied for initiation of automatic reordering:

The ‘Auto Reorder of Cheque Book’ option is turned on at the account level

The number of unused check leaves for the account is less than or equal to the reorder
level maintained at the account level. The system will pick up the number of leaves to be
reordered from the field ‘Reorder Number of Leaves’ maintained for the account.
The numbering of cheque leaves for the new Cheque Book will depend on the ‘Cheque Number
Unique for Branch’ option in the ‘Bank Parameters’ screen. If this option is checked, the
numbering will begin from the Last Number + 1 of the Cheque Book that was delivered last to any
account. If you do not select this option, the number will start from the Last Number +1 of the
Cheque Book delivered to the same account previously.
The value of ‘Include for Cheque Book Printing’ and ‘Cheque Type’ (specifications defined in the
‘Cheque Book Details’ screen) will be defaulted from the previous order of the Cheque Book.
3.2.4 Capturing Details about Specially Designated Nationals
Specially Designated Nationals (SDN) are those customers with whom you need to refrain from
trading in any form. The US government publishes a list of such nationals and circulates this list
among banks and other financial organizations. You can to maintain the details of SDNs in Oracle
FLEXCUBE.
The details of Specially Designated Nationals are updated and published by the US government
on a regular basis. You could download these details from their web site. You have two options to
replicate the contents of this file into Oracle FLEXCUBE. They are:
1. Upload the file into Oracle FLEXCUBE through the SDN Upload screen.
2. Maintain the details of each SDN manually.
Both these options have been elaborated upon in the subsequent sections.
Maintaining SDN Details Manually
Through the ‘Specially Designated Nationals’ screen you can capture the details of SDN
customers manually. Invoke this screen, by typing ‘STDSDNMN’ in the field at the top right corner
of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The screen is as shown below:
3-12
The following details have to be captured:
3.2.5

Name of the Specially Designated National

Date of Birth of the SDN: Specify the Date of Birth of the SDN in YYYYMMDD format

Country of Origin: You can specify the SDN’s country of origin by selecting
from the option list provided

Remarks: Any additional remarks, if required can be specified

Alias Names of the SDN: You can specify a maximum of fifteen alias names

Addresses of the SDN: You can specify a maximum of fifteen addresses (of address line
1 to address line 4) for a SDN
the same
Specifying your Preferences for Account Class
Preferences are the options or attributes that uniquely distinguish an account class. You can
specify the preferences of an account class in the ‘Preference’ screen. To invoke this screen,
click ‘Preferences’ button in ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen.
3-13
The screen is as shown below:
The following are the preferences that you can specify for an account class:

Limit Check – you can check this box to indicate that a limit check for sufficient availability
of funds in the account will be made for all accounts belonging to the account class

Overdraft Facility – if checked indicates that all accounts belonging to this class would be
allowed an overdraft facility (facility to draw a specified amount over and above the
balance in the account)

Interest Charges – if checked indicates that for interest and charges computation the
Interest and Charges module will process accounts linked to this class.

Track Accrued IC – if checked, indicates whether accrued interest in the Interest and
Charges module on an account linked to this class, would be considered while computing
credit utilization for the account.

Passbook Facility – if checked, indicates that accounts linked to the account class are
issued passbooks.

ATM Facility – if checked, indicates that accounts linked to the class will avail the ATM
facility

Daylight Limit – if checked indicates that you can specify daylight overdraft limit for all the
accounts belonging to this account class. While modifying the maintenance, if you
uncheck this box, the daylight overdraft limit will be made zero for all the accounts
belonging to this account class.
3-14

Debit/Credit Advices – If checked, indicates that for all accounts belonging to this class,
the system will generate a debit/credit advices on interest liquidation. The advices are
generated during end of day processing in SWIFT or/and MAIL format. You can also
specify this preference through the ‘Special Conditions’ screen.

Track Receivable – if checked, you can choose to block the subsequent credit that
happens to the settlement account (linked to this account class) of a loan contract or
retail teller contract, if the system detects insufficient funds in the account, during
liquidation. In other words, the system will track the account for receivables (credits). As
and when a credit happens, the funds will be allocated to the loan or the retail teller
contract for liquidation.

Posting Allowed – This check box is checked by default. Uncheck this check box to setup
Monetary Accounts for the selected Account Class.
This check box is provided to handle IRA Monetary Accounts. Using this facility, you can
avoid posting into the IRA Monetary Accounts from Teller/Journal screens and ensure
that the details are computed only through IRA subscriptions.
Uncheck this checkbox only for specific Inter-Branch Accounts.

Referral Required - enabling this option indicates whether a referral check should be
performed on accounts belonging to the account class. Consequently, the system checks
the available balance (not the current balance) while performing the referral checks for all
transactions involving the account. If a transaction involving the account results in the
account moving to overdraft, the account and transaction details will be sent to the
Referral Queue.

Lodgement Book - If you wish to allow orders of lodgement books for all accounts that
use an account class, you can indicate so, in the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen, by
selecting the Lodgement Book option.

Back Period Entry Allowed – if checked, indicates that back-valued entries can be posted
to account belonging to the class as long as the account is open. You will be allowed to
change this specification for a specific account.

Uncollected Funds Group Tracking - This check box indicates that group level limit
maintenance for uncollected funds is allowed for the account class. If you check this box,
it indicates that uncollected fund limits can be maintained for each group separately in the
accounts belonging to this account class. By default this box is left unchecked.

Net IC Entries – This check box indicates that interest and charges for a customer
account should be netted and posted into the customer account as one booking entry.
This check box is enabled only if you have checked ‘Interest Charges’.

Exempt/Include Withholding Tax on Applicability Change – If this box is checked, then
the system will deduct withholding tax for the document expired/Non-Submission period
and not for the whole liquidation cycle. If this check box is not checked, then the
withholding tax applicability depends on the check box ‘Withholding Tax’ at the customer
level during liquidation cycle. Either tax will be applicable during the whole liquidation
cycle or will not be applicable during that cycle. If the check box is checked, than then
Withholding tax is applicable based on the below two methods:
3-15


If the check box ‘Withholding Tax’ is checked at the customer level, then tax is
applicable for entire liquidation cycle irrespective of whether the certificate is expired
in the middle of the liquidation cycle.

If the check box ‘Withholding Tax’ is unchecked at the customer level, then tax will be
applicable only for those days for which certificate was expired,
Integrated Liquidity Management - check to indicate that the accounts created under this
account class would be part of an ILM Structure.
While posting back-valued transactions, the System verifies whether the Back Period Entry
Allowed option has been enabled for the account class. If the option has not been enabled an
error message is displayed. This check is also performed while uploading journal entry
transactions.
Replicate Customer Signature
Check this box to indicate that customer signature should be replicated. On checking this option,
the signature of the customer gets defaulted to account level.
No. of Days For Salary Block
Specify the number of days for salary block. At the time of salary credit in to a customer account,
the system will place an amount block for the number of days specified here from the date of
salary credit. The amount blocked will be equal to the loan instalments due during this period.
Example
For single loan installment:
No. Of Days for Salary Block
: 15 days.
Salary credit amount
: 10000 AED credited on 30-Oct-2009
Loan1 Installment Amt
: 5000 AED due on 05-Nov-2009
System will check for the Loan installments falling due till 14-NOV (salary credit on 30-Oct + 15). The system
will put an amount block of 5000 AED with expiry date as due date i.e. 05-Nov-2009 and Effective date as
Application date i.e. 30-Oct-2009. The created amount block will have amount block purpose code as ‘05’
and Remarks field will be populated with Loan A/c Number.
Note: For a given loan account schedule, all the applicable component amounts are summed up and a
consolidated amount block will be created.
These amount blocks created by system for hold on salary purpose cannot be amended by users and only
can be closed if required for the purpose of doing a manual liquidation for loan prepayment.
For multiple Loan instalments:
No. Of Days for Salary Block
: 15 days
Salary credit amount
: 10000 AED credited on 30-Oct-2009
Loan1 Installment Amt
: 5000 AED due on 05-Nov-2009
Loan2 Installment Amt
: 3000 AED due on 10-Nov-2009
3-16
In this case, 2 block amount transactions will be placed by system on 30-oct-2009 (on Salary credit date) in
the order of loan installment due date with block amounts.
No of days for Closing Unauthorized Accounts with No Activity
Specify the number of days after which the unauthorized accounts without any activity should be
automatically closed.
No of days for Closing Authorized Accounts with No Activity
Specify the number of days after which the authorized accounts without any activity should be
automatically closed.
Enabling Printing of Account Statistics
You can enable printing statistics in respect of accounts using an account class, either period
code-wise or financial year-wise, for the following customer information:

Low and High Balance for a period–The lowest and highest current balances for the
period.

Average credit and debit balance for a period–This is computed as the sum of
credit/(debit) current balances in a period, divided by the number of days of credit/(debit)
balance during the period.

Credit and debit days–The number of days the account was in credit/(debit) balance in
the period.

Credit and Debit Turnover–The credit/(debit) turnover for the period.

Excess days in debit balance–The number of days in a month when the account
exceeded the overdraft limits.

Overdraft Limit–This is computed by summing the temporary overdraft limit and the sublimit of the account. For each month, this would represent the limit on the last date of the
month.

Credit grade of the Customer–This would be the prevalent rating on the last day of the
period. For the current period, this information is provided up to the previous working day.
To enable printing of this information for all accounts using an account class, you must enable the
Account Statistics option in the Account Class Maintenance.
For each account class for which account statistics has been enabled, an accounting End of Day
(EOD) process updates the statistics table both period-wise and according to financial years. The
book-dated balances are used for computation of statistics, and the balances are maintained
according to accounting periods.
3-17
For information about viewing the period-wise account statistics, refer the section Querying on
Account Statistics, found earlier in this chapter.
Status Change Automatic
If you check this option, the status of the account will be changed automatically by the system as
per the conditions maintained in the ‘Status Rule Definition’ screen. If you do not select this
option, you have to change the status manually through the ‘Manual Status Change’ screen.
These screens are discussed in detail in the subsequent sections of this document. This
specification will be defaulted to all the accounts reporting to this account class.
Exclude Same Day Reversal transaction from Statement
If you do not wish transactions booked and reversed on the same day to be reflected in the
account statement, you can specify the preference here. This feature is applicable only for the
customer account legs and not for the related GL legs. Also, reversals made through the DE
module will not be considered for exclusion.
Your specification for this at the account class level defaults to all accounts involving the class.
You can change it for a specific account.
For comparing transactions the System will look for similarity of reference number and date.
Consolidation for Inward Clearing
You need to indicate whether or not consolidation is required for inward clearing transactions in a
batch at the Account Class level. The indication for this option is carried forward to the ‘Customer
Account Maintenance’ screen. If this option is unchecked here, it cannot be checked in the
‘Customer Account Maintenance screen’.
3.2.5.1 Processing for Consolidation of Inward Clearing
During the Inward Clearing process, the consolidated entry for clearing will be passed according
to the following grouping:

Remitter’s Account

Clearing Product

Instrument Currency

Remitter’s branch

End point
A consolidated clearing entry will be passed using a separate Transaction Code maintained in the
‘Clearing Product Preferences’ screen. This Transaction Code should be set with Cheque
Mandatory option as No in the ‘Transaction Code Maintenance’ screen.
One consolidated clearing entry will be passed for each of the above groups. Entries will be
passed against a common reference no. generated for each of the groups. After the consolidated
entry has been passed, each individual instrument will be processed separately to pass charge
entries (if applicable) at the transaction level.
3-18
Specifying Turnover Limit Preferences
You can specify turnover limits for an account class and thereby monitor the turnover in all
accounts linked to the account class.
Turnover Limit Code
Specify a turnover limit code that should be linked to the account class. The adjoining option list
displays all valid turnover limit codes maintained in the system using the ‘Turnover Limit
Maintenance’ screen. You can choose the appropriate one.
3.2.6 Specifying Liquidation Preferences for Debit Interest and Charges
You must specify the liquidation preferences for debit interest and charges, for those accounts
classes where interest/charge has to be debited from a Receivable GL before actually debiting
the customer account. This feature is applicable only for the debit interest and any charges on the
account calculated through the IC module. The preferences that you need to specify are:

Liquidate Using Receivable - Indicates whether receivable tracking is required for IC
Debit interest and IC charges

Debit Notice – enabling this option indicates that a notification needs to be sent to
customers before debiting the customer account for the interest / charge calculated for
the period.

Liquidation Days – specifies the number of working days from the actual liquidation date
before the interest/charge can be liquidated into the customer account. Working days are
calculated on the basis of the Local Holiday Calendar.

Liquidation Mode – debit interest or charges can be liquidated either Manually or
Automatically. If you choose the automatic mode of liquidation, debit interest or charges
are liquidated automatically as part of the BOD process on the liquidation date. However,
after having specified Auto as the mode of liquidation, if you wish to liquidate them
manually for a specific account, the System intimates you with an override message.
Manual interest liquidation can be triggered through the ‘Debit Interest Liquidation’
screen. Manual liquidation is recommended during Account Closure.

Verify Funds –enabling this option indicates that an available balance check should be
performed for receivable tracking. As a result, the System performs the available balance
check before debiting the account. The available balance also includes the limit amount.
Verification of funds is applicable only in the case of Auto-Liquidation. If you leave this
option unchecked, the System performs a ‘force-liquidation’ regardless of whether the
account has sufficient funds or not.
Note the following:

You will not be allowed to change these preferences at the account level. However in the
Amounts and Dates section of the ‘Customer Accounts Maintenance’ screen, both the
total debit interest due as well as the charges due, are displayed.

If there is any outstanding interest or charges on the account, the outstanding amount is
displayed as an override while saving the transaction involving the account.
3-19

While closing an account closure, the System verifies whether there is any outstanding
debit interest or charges on the account. You will need to liquidate these before Account
Closure.
An error log is created to store the error details of accounts for which liquidation could not be
performed due to the following reasons:

The Verify Funds option is enabled and partial liquidation is performed

The Verify Funds option is enabled and the account has insufficient funds

Accounting entries do not get passed successfully irrespective of whether the Verify
Funds option is set or not.
Refer the End of Day processing for Debiting Receivable GLs section in the Daily Processing of
IC chapter of the IC User Manual for details on end of day processes on Auto and Manual
liquidation.
3.2.7
Maintaining Details for Free Banking
For account classes for which a free banking period is being provided, you can indicate the free
banking parameters. These include:

The number of days after the account opening date, for which no charges would be
levied on the account. This is the free banking period. Charging for the account would
commence when the free banking period has elapsed.

Whether an advice (charge start advice) is to be sent to the customer, indicating the
commencement of charging on the account

The number of days before the charge start date, the charge start advice is to be sent to
the customer, indicating the commencement of charging on the account.
3.2.8 Specifying Initial Funding Preferences
You need to specify the following details pertaining to initial funding for opening accounts under
the account class.
Event Class Code
Specify the event class code maintained for initial funding process for the module code ‘DE’. This
adjoining option list displays all valid event class codes maintained in the system. You can
choose the appropriate one.
Charge Role to Head Code
Specify the class code that you wish to use for posting charge-related accounting entries for initial
funding. This adjoining option list displays all valid class codes maintained in the system. You can
choose the appropriate one.
3-20
Refer the section ‘Maintaining Event Class for Account Initial Funding’ in the chapter titled
‘Creating Classes’ under Modularity User Manual for further details about the event class code.
3.2.9 Maintaining Provisioning Details
When you define an account class, you can specify whether provisioning is applicable for
accounts using the class. You can make the following specifications in the Provisioning Details
section in the ‘Account Classes’ screen:

Auto Provisioning Required - Check this box if provisioning is applicable

Provision Frequency - Frequency at which the provisioning would be done, either daily or
monthly
The frequency you define here is only applicable if you have indicated individual accountwise status processing for accounts in the Branch Parameters. If you have indicated status
processing at Group/CIF level, then the provisioning batch process executes at the frequency
maintained in the ‘Branch Parameters’ screen for your branch, and not at the frequency
maintained in the Account Classes screen.

The currency in which the provisioning amount must be calculated – either account
currency or local currency

Default exposure category for accounts using the account class

Event class for which the provisioning accounting entries would be defined
The specifications you make here are inherited by any account that uses the account class.
In addition to these preferences, you must also indicate:

The accounting roles and heads representing the GLs to which the accounting entries for
provisioning must be passed, for each account status

Whether provisioning entries for an account must be rebooked when provisioning is done
after an automatic status change for the account

Specify the provision code to pick up the provision percentage for the calculation. The
adjoining option list displays the provision code maintained in the ‘Provision Coverage
Maintenance’ screen.
You can maintain these details for each account status in the ‘Status Details’ screen.
3.2.10 Maintaining Escrow Details
The following Escrow details can be maintained for the account class:
Escrow Transfer Applicable
Check this box to enable Escrow transfer for the accounts belonging to the selected account
class.
3-21
Transaction Code
Select the Transaction Code to be used for Escrow transfer from the adjoining option list. The
option list displays only those transaction codes which are not enabled for Escrow processing at
the ‘Transaction Code Maintenance’ screen.
This is a mandatory input if Escrow transfer is enabled for the account class.
Transaction Code for Reversal
Select the transaction code to be used for Escrow Reversal transactions from the adjoining
option-list. The option list displays only those transaction codes which are not enabled for Escrow
processing at the ‘Transaction Code Maintenance’ screen.
During account class amendment, the system does not allow you to disable Escrow process
for an account class if a Project account has been created using that account class.
Cash Deposit Limit on Trust Account
If you have checked the box ‘Escrow Transfer Applicable’, you will have to specify the maximum
cash that can be deposited in the Trust accounts under this account class.
3.2.11 Maintaining Status Codes for Account Class
Current and Savings accounts that have not generated any interest over a specific period or have
remained inactive with interest overdue may be identified as ‘NPAs’ (Non-Performing Asset). In
Oracle FLEXCUBE, you can assign different status codes to an account class, which will be
applicable to all the accounts under it. The accounts will move from one status to the other based
on the number of days they have remained inactive in the system. The status of an account will
determine whether the account should be marked as an NPA or not.
Further, you can also specify the reporting lines (for GL, Central Bank, and Head Office) to which
accounting entries should be passed when an account moves from one status to the other. You
can post all debit and credit balances of one account class to a single General Ledger account.
Conversely, you also have the option of posting debits and credits to separate GLs.
The status codes and the reporting lines for each status may be defined in the ‘Status Details’
screen. Click the ‘GL Lines’ button in the ‘Account Classes’ screen to invoke it.
3-22
The screen is as shown below:
You can specify the following details in this screen:
Status
You can select the different status codes applicable to the account class, in this field. Use the
Add icon to define each status and the attributes for the same. You can use the navigation icons
to move from one status to the other.
Only status codes with status type ‘Account’ will be available in the option-list if the Status
Processing Basis is defined as ‘Contract/Account’ for all branches, in the Branch Parameters. If
the Status Processing Basis is defined as ‘Group/CIF’ level for any branch, then the statuses of
type ‘Both’ are available. In this case, it is mandatory to link all the statuses defined.
On selection of the status, the associated description will be displayed alongside.
3.2.12 Specifying Reporting line Details
Dr and Cr GL Lines
Select the debit GL account, to which all debit balances within a specific account class will report
to, when it moves to the status being defined. You can identify the debit GL from the list of
existing GLs. Likewise, all credits within a particular account class will report to the GL account
that you have identified to track credits.
Dr and Cr Central Bank Lines
Select the Central Bank Debit line to which all debit accounts belonging to an account class
should report to when it moves to the selected status. You have maintained Central Bank Debit
lines in the ‘Reporting Lines Maintenance’ screen. You can select the appropriate CB Debit Line
from the available option-list.
3-23
Similarly, all accounts belonging to an account class, if in credit should report to a Central Bank
Credit Line for the selected status. You can identify the CB Credit Line that should be associated
with the status from the option-list available.
Dr and Cr Head Office Lines
This is the Debit Head Office GL maintained in the ‘Reporting Lines Maintenance’ screen to which
all accounts belonging to this class will report, if they move to the status being defined.
Similarly, select the Credit Head Office GL maintained in the ‘Reporting Lines Maintenance’
screen to which all accounts belonging to this class will report to, when they move to the status
being defined.
As a mandatory requirement, you have to associate the status ‘NORM’ (Normal) when
maintaining status codes for an account class.
Accounting Roles and Heads for Provisioning
In addition to the provisioning preferences that you specify for an account class, you must also
maintain the accounting roles and heads representing the GLs to which the accounting entries for
provisioning must be passed, for each account status. You can maintain this information in the
‘Status Details’ screen, when you define each of the status codes.
Rebook Provisioning on Status Change
In the ‘Status Details’ screen, you can indicate whether provisioning entries for an account must
be rebooked when provisioning is done after an automatic status change for the account.
Rebooking essentially means that fresh provisioning is done, after writing back the previous
provisioning amount.
The provisioning batch process, when executed, not only computes the provisioning amount; it
also records the current status of the account and checks whether the current status is different
from the status that was prevalent when the process was previously executed. If so, the old
provisioning amount is reversed (if the Rebook Provision option has been set in the Status
Details), and the entries for the new provisioning amount are booked into the provisioning and
write back GLs maintained for the current status in the Status Details.
If the Rebook Provision has not been set, there is no reversal of the old provisioning amount, and
the differential provisioning entries are passed, as usual, into the GLs maintained for the new
status.
3.2.13 Maintaining Auto Deposits
Auto deposits are the linked deposit accounts to the savings accounts. These accounts are
created once the threshold balance exceeds in the customer accounts. You can maintain these
accounts using ‘Auto Deposits’ screen. Click the button ‘Auto Deposit’ in the ‘Account Class
Maintenance’ screen to invoke it.
3-24
The screen is as shown below:
You have to specify the following fields in this screen.
Account Class
Specify the deposit type of account class for the auto deposit account.
Transaction Code
Specify the transaction code (DPN - New deposit account) for the book event to trigger at the
time of creation of auto deposit account.
Currency
Specify the currency in which the deposit account has to created.
Minimum Required Balance
Specify the balance that is required to be maintained at the linked savings account. If any balance
exists beyond this balance in the account then the system creates an auto deposit account as
part of batch process.
Cluster ID
The system displays the cluster ID linked with the deposit account class linked to the saving
account class.
Def Rate Code
Select the code of the differential rate; whether ‘Mid’ or ‘Standard’.
Def Rate Type
Select the type of differential rate code; whether ‘Mid’ or ‘Buy’ or ‘Sell’
Sweep Mode
Select the mode of sweep from the following options.

Automatic - For the deposit to be created as part of the batch
3-25

Manual - For the deposit to be created manually
Break Method
Select the method in which the break of auto deposit should happen, from the following options.

MAXB - The system breaks the maximum valued deposit account or the deposit account
having the maximum balance in order of descending amount.

MINB - The system breaks the deposit account having minimum balance in order of
ascending amount.

FIFO - The system breaks the deposit account in order of chronological account creation
date.

LIFO - The system breaks the deposit account in order of reverse chronological account
creation date (the latest created deposit account breaks first).
Provide Interest On Broken Deposit
Check this field to indicate the system to calculate interest on the deposits. This is done when the
attached account class is mapped to the IC product.
Break Deposits First
Check this field to indicate the system to break the deposit accounts created and transfer the
proceedings to the savings account. The system breaks the deposits when the savings account
does not have sufficient balance to withdraw the amount.
In this case the system breaks the auto deposit account and restores the savings account with
balance to allow withdrawing the money.
Example
The customer has the total balance in the account for $5675 including $650 as auto deposit. He withdraws
$5500 from an ATM. As part of intraday batch (DESWPBAT), the system breaks the auto deposit account of
$650 and restores the balance amount to savings. So his current standings would be $175 in his savings
account and he does not hold any auto deposit account.
3.2.14 Maintaining Rules for Automatic Status Change
If you have opted for automatic status change for all accounts belonging to an account class, you
have to maintain the criteria based on which the system will bring about the status change
automatically.
You can define the different criteria in the ‘Status Rule Definition’ screen. Click the button ‘Status
Rule’ in the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen to invoke it.
3-26
The screen is as shown below:
In this screen, you can define five conditions for each status applicable to an account class. An
account will be said to be in a specific status if any one of the five conditions associated with the
status holds true for an account. Conversely, if all the conditions are false, the account will
automatically move to the next available status for which the condition is true.
The following elements are available based on which you can build a condition for automatic
status change. You can associate each of these elements with an account, in the ‘Customer
Accounts Maintenance’ screen.
The set of elements are as follows:

Frozen

Dormant

Nodebits

Nocredits

Stoppayment

Current Status
In addition, the following elements will also be available for processing:

OD (overdraft) Days

Inactive Days

Overline Days

TOD (Temporary Overdraft) Days

Customer Classification
3-27
For OD Accounts, you can maintain the following rules for CROF and ‘SUSP’/’WOFF’ statuses of
‘Write-off’ processing:
Status
Rule
Remarks
CROF
OD_DAYS>150
AND
OD_DAYS<=1095
If the account is overdraft for more than 150
days, then you can change the account
status as write-off
SUSP / WOFF
OD_DAYS>1095
If the account is overdraft for more than
1095 days, then you can change the account
status as suspended
Logical Operators
Logical Operators are indicators of certain conditions that you specify while building a rule. These
operators are used in combination with the elements discussed earlier. The following is a list of
logical operators that you would require to build a status rule:
AND
The conjunction ‘and’
OR
The conjunction ‘or’
>
Greater than
>=
Greater than or equal to (please note that there is no space
between the two symbols)
<
Less than
<=
Less than or equal to (please note that there is no space
between the two symbols)
<>
Not equal to (please note that there is no space between the
two symbols)
=
Equal to
Status Reason Code
Specify the reason code for the status movement from the adjoin option list.
Status Reason Description
System displays the reason description based on the reason code selected.
Forward
Check this box to indicate that the forward status movement is automatic. If this box is
unchecked, then the status movement will be manual.
3-28
Reverse
Check this box to indicate that the reverse status movement is automatic. If this box is
unchecked, then the status movement will be manual.
Oracle FLEXCUBE allows data store for tracking of SOD debit interest due. During Interest
liquidation for debit interest, the system populates the SOD Debit Interest Due Data Store with the
Amount Due as debit interest for the SOD utilized amount and the due date of payment for the
interest amount.
The debit interest due amount is adjusted in the SOD utilized amount and the system checks for
any credit entries for the SOD corresponding to the debit interest. During EOD, if any credit entry
exists for the account, then the system does adjustments on the amount due for the SOD debit
interest due data store. The system also adjusts the debit interest payment against the oldest
available debit interest due amount, and so on.
Oracle FLEXCUBE provides SDEs for ‘SOD Due Count’ and ‘SOD Overdue Days’ for status rule
generation. During EOD while running the status update batch, the system calculates SDE ‘SOD
Due Count’ value as the count of the records having due amount not equal to zero from the SOD
debit interest due data store. The system updates the ‘SOD Overdue Days’ with the number of
days since the last debit interest payment done for the account.
Oracle FLEXCUBE provides an account status called ‘DIDF’ for an SOD account, which is
available as part of ‘Status Rule Screen’. If the ‘SOD Due Count ’or ‘SOD Overdue Days’ satisfies
the condition specified in the status change rule, then the system changes the status for the
account to ‘DIDF’.
While running the status change batch, the system updates the ‘No Debit’ flag as ‘Y’ for ‘DIDF’
status account. If payment for the debit interest happens on the SOD account against the utilized
amount, and if on recalculation the value of SDE ‘SOD Due Count’, or ‘SOD Overdue Days’ is not
met, the status batch changes the status of the OD account from ‘DIDF’ to the previous account
status and updates the ‘No Debit’ flag as ‘N’.
Note the following:
3.2.14.1

Amount block is not considered because of the possibilities of simultaneous utilizations of
the SOD.

Any credit transaction towards the SOD account is tracked under interest due for the
SOD.

Any impact on account status after the execution of account status change batch for the
day, gets reflected in the next EOD execution.
Modifying Account Status Manually
For status movements that have to be performed manually on a customer account, you can use
the ‘Manual Status Change’ screen. Invoke this screen, by typing ‘STDSTMNT’ in the field at the
top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
3-29
Select ‘New’ from the Actions menu in the Application toolbar. The system will display
‘Transaction Branch’ screen. Here you can select the transaction branch.
Here you are allowed to book other branch transactions from the logged in branch. Also, you can
query other branch transactions from the logged in branch. The system defaults the logged-in
branch by default as the transaction branch.
Transaction Branch
Select the appropriate branch from the list of branches available in the option list. This screen will
be available only for those users who has ‘Multi Branch Operational’ check box enabled at ‘User
Maintenance’ Screen.
While clicking ‘Ok’ button, the system validates the access rights of the selected branch and
function for the user. If you don’t have appropriate rights on the selected branch and function, the
system would raise an error message. If you select a valid branch, the system updates the same
as transaction branch and the transaction would be posted for this branch.
The system performs the action level access rights validation only on ‘Save’ operation.
3-30
After selecting the Transaction Branch, you can enter the remaining details in the ‘Manual Status
Change’ screen.
Provide the following details in this screen to facilitate a manual status change:
Account No
Select the customer account for which you are marking a manual status change, from the optionlist provided.
On selection of the account, the system will display the current status of the account as well as
the date on which the account moved to the current status.
New Status
Specify the new status of the account. You can select the appropriate status from this list.
If Status Processing Basis specified in the Branch Parameters for all the branches is
‘Contract/Account’, only status codes maintained with status type ‘Account’ (in the ‘Status Codes
Maintenance’ screen) will be available in the option-list. If Status Processing Basis for even one
of the branches is specified as ‘Group/CIF’ level, then the only statuses available will be of type
‘Both’.
Status Code
Specify the status code for the status movement from the adjoin option list.
Status Reason Description
System displays the status reason description based on the status code selected.
3-31
Account Statuses
In addition to the new status, you can also mark the account with any one of the following
statuses, if required:

No Credit – if checked, no credit movement will be allowed on the account

No Debit – the system will not allow debit movements on the account if you select this
option

Frozen – if selected, no activity will be allowed on the account

Posting Allowed – if checked, posting of accounting entries will be allowed in the account
Status Change Automatic
You can select this option if you want the subsequent status change for the account to be
performed automatically by the system. After the account moves to the new status specified
here, all subsequent status movements will be triggered automatically, during the EOD run for the
branch. However, the changes will come into effect only upon authorization of the details
maintained here. At a later date, you can switch back to the manual mode by unchecking this
option and having the same authorized.
The manual status movement that you specify in this screen has to be authorized for the new
status of the account to come into effect.
3.2.14.2
Maintaining Status Change Processing
For accounts marked with automatic status change, you can execute a batch process at EOD to
trigger the status movement and other associated changes. Use the ‘Account Status Update
Processing’ screen available in the Application Browser to begin the batch process.
If the Status Processing Basis defined for the branch is ‘Group/CIF’ level, the worst status for all
loans and overdrafts accounts is calculated for a Group/CIF level. This status is displayed in the
respective Group/CIF screens as well as at the respective account and contract screens. The
individual status of each account and contract is also displayed in the accounts screen as
‘Account Derived Status’.
Refer the ‘Products’ chapter of the Interest and Charges user manual for more details.
3.2.15 Maintaining Sequence for Funds Allocation
The allocation of funds will occur as per the product sequence you maintain in the ‘Product
Maintenance’ screen invoked from the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen. Click the ‘Amt Block’
button to access this screen.
3-32
The screen is as shown below:
In this screen, you will specify the sequence of products based on which funds will be made
available when a credit is posted to an account with a track receivable option. The sequence
number is automatically generated by the system. All authorized products of your bank will be
available in the option-list. On selection of the product, the product description will appear
alongside.
Whenever a credit happens to an account with a track receivable option, the system will check if
the account has any receivable being tracked against it. If yes, the amount is blocked as a
receivable and this process continues until the amount needed for liquidation becomes fully
available.
The batch process run as part of EOD/BOD will liquidate the loan contract or retail teller
contracts.
If the amount received is not sufficient for full liquidation, then depending on the minimum amount
required for liquidation, the system would initiate a partial liquidation for loans but for retail teller
contracts liquidation will be initiated only when full amount is available.
The following example illustrates the manner in which the system will use the sequence for
allocation of funds:
Assume that you have maintained the following product sequence for funds allocation:
Sequence No.
Product
1
ADBN
2
LDBD
3
ABCD
The liquidation schedule dates for the various loan contracts are as follows:
3-33
Contract
Liq. Schedule Dt.
LDBD001
1 January 2002
LDBD002
1 January 2002
ADBN001
2 January 2002
ABCD001
2 January 2002
Liqd. Amt. (in USD)
st
1000
st
500
nd
1000
nd
500
Further, all contracts are marked for auto liquidation and the settlement account for all contracts is A1. The
st
balance in account A1 as on 1 January 2002 is 500 USD.
Batch liquidation
run as part of
st
BOD/EOD on 1
Jan.
Liquidation does not occur as the system detects
insufficient funds in A1 (only 400 USD). The
account is marked for receivable tracking and a
block is placed on 400 USD.
A credit of 500
nd
USD to A1 on 2
Jan.
The total amount blocked gets updated to 1000
USD. Since we have two contracts involving the
same product (LDBD) maturing on the same date,
funds will be allocated to the first contract,
LDBD001 (based on the Contract Reference
Number). Subsequent credits to the account will
be used towards loan LDBD002.
Since contracts with LDBD have earlier schedule
dates, funds will be allocated to them though, as
per the product sequence, contracts with ADBN
should receive the funds first. The liquidation
schedule date takes precedence in this case.
Further credits to account, A1 will be allocated
against the contract ADBN001 followed by the
contract ABCD001. This will be based on the
product sequence number since both contracts
have the same schedule dates.
Within a contract, allocation of funds towards the
various components like interest, penalty interest
etc. will be determined by the ‘Liquidation Order’
maintained for the loan product.
To sum up, the schedule date of the loan contract
takes precedence followed by the product
sequence and finally the liquidation order.
If insufficient funds are detected in an account with a receivable tracking, the system will
trigger the event ‘LBLK’ indicating that enough funds are not available and that subsequent
credits made to the account will be blocked as a receivable.
3-34
3.2.16 Maintaining Transaction Restrictions for Account Class
You can place restrictions on transactions involving customer accounts, at the account class
level. As discussed earlier (for customer account), these restrictions get defaulted to all accounts
that are linked to the account class. But you are allowed to change these restrictions for individual
accounts as well.
To maintain the restrictions click the ‘Restriction’ button in the ‘Account Classes’ screen. The
‘Product and Transaction Codes Restriction’ screen is displayed.
The restrictions can be based on:

Products

Transaction Codes
Validation of Restrictions
During maintenance or online operations, in the respective contract screens for the restricted
transactions, when you specify the customer account, the system checks whether the account
class used by the specified account is restricted for the product that has been selected, or the
debit/credit transaction type. If so, an override is sought when such contracts are saved.
3.2.17 Maintaining Details of Account Statements Generation
To receive the details of account balances you need to capture the relevant information in the MT
941/MT942 message. The account balance details can be linked to the message by employing
the statement screen. To invoke this screen click on the ‘Statement’ button, in the ‘Account Class
Maintenance’ screen. You need to specify the details for an MT 941/MT942 message.
3-35
The screen is as shown below:
This screen contains the details necessary for the account generation parameters. The message
details the balance of an account or group of accounts under a particular account class. The
account balances indicate the condition of the account for an identified time period.
3.2.17.1
Specifying Interim Transactions Report
Generate Message
Check this box to indicate that the accounts belonging to the account class are to be considered
for periodic interim statement generation i.e., MT942.
Generate Message Only On Movement
Check this box to indicate that the interim statement needs to be generated only if additional
entries have been posted subsequent to the previous interim statement generation.
Report Transaction Since
This is a list of all the transactions the accounts under a class have undergone, on basis of
which the transactions would be reported in the interim account statement. You can choose the
appropriate values applicable:

Previous MT942: This indicates that all transactions posted and authorized since
previous MT942 would be sent in the current interim statement

Previous MT940/MT950: This indicates that all transactions posted and authorized since
previous MT940/MT950 would be sent in the current interim statement. If this option is
selected, user will have to specify the cycle of account statement to be considered.
3-36
Minimum Debit Amount and Currency
Specify the minimum transaction amount for the debit transaction, which is eligible for reporting in
the interim statement. This amount should be qualified by a currency. The amount for the
corresponding account currency will be defaulted from here while opening the account.
Minimum Credit Amount and Currency
Specify the minimum transaction amount for the credit transaction, which is eligible for reporting
in the interim statement. This amount should be qualified by a currency. The amount for the
corresponding account currency will be defaulted from here while opening the account.
Generate Balance
To indicate that accounts under certain account classes are to be considered for generation of
their balance messages, check this box. The valid values for this action are Y and N.
Of
Select the mode of message for balance generation form the option list
Report Transaction Since
This is a list of all the transactions the accounts under a class have undergone, in the interval of
balance messages generated for the accounts under the respective classes. You can choose the
appropriate values applicable:

Previous MT940: This indicates all transactions posted and authorized since the issue of
a previous MT 940 in the current balance report.

Previous MT941: This indicates all transactions posted and authorized since the issue of
a previous MT 941 in the current balance report.

Previous MT950: This indicates all transactions posted and authorized since the issue of
a previous MT 950 in the current balance report.
You can synchronize the time instance by hours for generation of balance messages by clicking
the ‘Times’ button.
3-37
This screen is employed to indicate the the time instance in hours for the generation of the
balance reports.
Message Generation Time
Specify the timing for generation of the MT 941/MT942 messages. You can specify the time
interval in hours only.
A new message type is created for the balance report process which can be run as part of a
scheduled task. This message type is ACST_BALANCE and ACST_INT_DTL.
3.2.17.2
Balance Statement Handoff
The balance statement can be handed off as part of scheduled task under Oracle. You need to
assign its frequency in hours. This process is initiated for all accounts requiring a balance account
statement. As discussed previously the time for generation of the statement is determined and
specified. In case of no subsequent transactions reports, the statement is not generated.
3.2.17.3
Assigning Balance Statement as Job
The balance statement can be facilitated to run as part of a scheduled job as part of the Oracle
jobs initiated during processing.
The ‘Jobs Browser’ screen of the application provides you the facility to run the balance
statement as a synchronized task, subject to specified time intervals in hours.
Invoke the ‘Jobs Browser’ screen from the application typing ‘CSSJOBBR’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and click on the adjoining arrow button.
3-38
The screen is as shown below:
Select the option ‘Generate Balance Report’ from the Process option list. All associated accounts
of the particular branch that have been marked for generation of balance statements are procured
by Oracle FLEXCUBE.
The debit and credit accounts considered since the previous issue of an MT 941 are picked for
the current processing. The previous messages are based on the parameters maintained for
each account. This processing produces details of the statement generation.
3.2.17.4
Generation of Ad hoc Reports
Balance reports for each account under an account class can be generated on an ad hoc basis.
The Ad Hoc report generation screen is used for capturing details of a balance report sent ad
hoc. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘ACDADCRP’ in the upper right corner of the
application toolbar, and clicking the arrow adjacent it.
3-39
Branch Code
The branch to which the account marked for balance report generation belongs is displayed; you
cannot change or modify this value.
Account
Select the account which has been identified for generation of a balance statement, from the
option list. The account balance of this account is generated as an outgoing statement.
Swift Message Type
Select the type of message required to be sent. As the message is a balance statement, select
MT941/MT942.
Click on the ‘Generate Statement’ button to initiate the generation of balance statement for the
account you have selected. This process would pick up the entire debit and credit component
accounts created since the issue of a previous MT941, MT942, MT950 or MT940 are included in
the generated statement.
You can examine the details of the generated message, to ensure that all details entered are
correct. Click on the ‘View’ button, to observe the outgoing message.
You can examine the message for ensuring the information entered is complete. You can only
view the details of the message; no input of additional information is supported at this stage.
3-40
3.2.18 Specifying Regulation D Applicability for Account Class
For an account class, you can define whether the Regulation D limits are applicable, and the
period over which the limits would be applicable. In the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen,
click the ‘REG’ button to invoke the ‘Reg Details’ screen. You can specify the Regulation D
applicability details in this screen.
If you indicate the periodicity of Regulation D applicability as ‘Statement Cycle’, the restricted
transactions would be counted over the primary statement cycle defined for the account class.
The Regulation D applicability details specified for an account class would default to all accounts
using the class. However, you can make changes to these details when you set up a customer
account that uses the account class.
3.2.19 Assigning Preferred Branches, Currencies and Customers
In addition to what you have specified in the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen you have the
option of specifying the following for an accounts class:

List of allowed or disallowed branches and allowed or disallowed currencies

List of allowed and disallowed customer categories and allowed and disallowed
customers
You can specify the branch and currency preferences through the ‘Account Class – Branch and
Currency Preferences’ screen.
Click ‘Branches/Currencies’ in the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen. The ‘Account Class –
Branch and Currency Preferences’ screen will be displayed.
3-41
The screen is as shown below:
In this screen you can specify the following for an account class:

Those branches to which all parameters defined for this account class should be
available

Those currencies in which all customer accounts linked to this account class can operate
3.2.20 Maintaining Branch Preferences
Customer accounts maintained in any branch can be linked to any account class. However, you
have the option of restricting the linkage of customer accounts in a particular branch or branches
to an account class.
Example
Your bank has a total of 25 branches. Branch 001 and 004 handles only Corporate Customers. For an
account class, say, SAV-IND (savings accounts of individuals) you would like to disallow linkage of all
customer accounts of branch 001 and 004.
To specify this, click on disallowed since the disallowed branch list is smaller than the allowed
branch list. From the list of Available Branches select 001 and click the adjoining arrow. Repeat
the procedure for 004. 001 and 004 will be listed under disallowed branches.
For specifying the allowed list of branches, first click on allowed. You will notice that the list
title changes accordingly to allowed and vice versa. You should select allowed or disallowed
depending upon the length of the list.
3-42
3.2.21 Maintaining Currency Preferences
For all accounts under this account class you have the option of specifying currencies in which
transactions are allowed/disallowed.
Example
You want to restrict all account level transactions under the account class Corporations for corporate type
accounts to four important currencies only, say - USD, GBP, JPY, and DEM. You can specify the same. But
currency preference needs to be accompanied by specifications regarding the minimum balance limit in
each currency.
To do this, click the ‘Currency Preference’ button. The ‘Account Class - Currency Preferences’
screen will be displayed.
All the allowed currencies you have defined for this account class will be displayed in the option
list adjoining the ’Currency Code’ field. You can enter the minimum balance that should be
maintained against each currency. You can also specify the minimum amount that should be
deposited at account opening. This value should not be less than the minimum balance for the
currency. Additionally, you can specify charges that should be levied against each currency for
opening a customer account. You can also maintain the maximum number of ATM transactions
that can be carried out on every currency. Similarly, you can maintain the maximum cash that can
be withdrawn from an ATM for every currency. If the box ‘Escrow Transfer Applicable’ is checked
for the account class, you can capture currency-wise cash deposit limit for the Trust accounts
linked to the account class.
3.2.22 Maintaining Customer Preferences
Instead of linking each customer account to an account class, a customer category is linked to
the class.
3-43
For an account class you should specify the category that should be linked to it and also specify if
all customers under each of the categories are to be linked to the account class. In the ‘Account
Class - Customer List’ screen you have the option of specifying the categories that should be
linked to this account class and within a category you can also restrict individual customers to be
linked to the class.
To indicate allowed customer categories click the ‘Customer/Categories’ button. The ‘Account
Class - Customer List’ screen will be invoked.
In this screen you define the following:

A list of allowed or disallowed customer categories

A list of disallowed customers (if any) under the allowed category
For an account class you need to specify the customer categories that should be linked to it and
also customers within a category who should not be allowed to be linked to this account class.
Example
Requirement
You are capturing the features of a Nostro account class called NostroLCY, you would like to:

Associate the customer category called Banks with NostroLCY

Disallow a customer called Midas-Bank associated with the customer category called
Banks from using the features of this class

Grant your customer Morgan Stanley linked to the customer category called Financial
Institutions all rights associated with NostroLCY
Procedure
In the Selection Indicator field click on Allowed (since your allowed list is smaller and therefore easier to
indicate).
3-44
1. Highlight and select the Customer Categories called Banks and Financial Institutions in the Available
Categories list and click the adjoining arrow.
2. Next, highlight Financial Institutions and click adjoining arrow against Customers. It will display the
entire list of customer accounts maintained under the customer category Financial Institutions
3. Select Morgan Stanley. It will be listed in the first row. To allow this customer the parameters assigned
to this account class check the small square box alongside
4. To add a row, click the Add icon. To delete an extra row, click the Delete icon
5. To disallow Midas Bank, click on Banks under available categories. Click the adjoining arrow against
Customers, to display a list of all the customers under this category. Select Midas Bank. Since you
would like to disallow this customer do not check the square box against it
Check the square box to allow a customer the parameters assigned to this account class.
Leave the box unchecked to disallow a customer from being assigned to this account class.
3.2.23 Specifying Balance Account Codes
To generate account numbers as per the requirements of NBU (National Bank of Ukraine),
special numbers called balance account codes are maintained. Every account class will be linked
to a set of balance account codes. The account numbers of all accounts belonging to an account
class should start with any of the balance account codes linked to that account class.
3-45
You can indicate the list of balance account codes to be linked to an account class in the
‘Balance Account Code’ screen. Click Balance Account Codes in ‘Account Class Maintenance’
screen to invoke this screen.
The account class and its description get defaulted in this screen. You can specify the following
details here:
Balance Account Code
Specify the balance account code to be linked to the account class or select the same from the
option list provided. All balance account codes maintained in ‘Balance Account Code
Maintenance’ screen are displayed here.
The following table indicates the account codes to be maintained for different types of account
classes:
Account class
Balance accounts according to NBU chart of accounts
Current accounts of legal
entities
2600,2601,2602,2603,2604,2605,2606
Current accounts of individual
persons
2620, 2622, 2625
Budgetary current accounts
2520, 2523, 2526, 2530, 2531, 2541, 2542, 2544, 2545,
3-46
Account class
Balance accounts according to NBU chart of accounts
2553, 2555, 2560, 2561, 2562, 2565, 2570, 2571, 2572
Savings Account
2620, 2625
Current accounts of election
funds , non banking financial
organizations
2640, 2641, 2642, 2643, 2650, 2655
Deposits of legal entities
2610, 2611, 2615
Deposits of individual persons
2630, 2635
Budgetary deposits
2525, 2546
Deposits of non banking
financial organizations
2651, 2652
3.2.23.1 Maintaining Balance Account Codes
You need to maintain balance account codes to be used for generating account number
according as per the requirements of NBU (National Bank of Ukraine), You can maintain balance
account codes in ‘Balance Account Code Maintenance’ screen.
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDBALAC’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can specify the following details in this screen:
Balance Account Code
Specify the balance account code to be used to indicate the type of an account class.
3-47
The balance account code should not start with zero (0). If you specify an account code that
starts with the digit ‘0’, then the system displays the following error message
The First Number Cannot be 0
The balance account code is applicable only if the country of the current branch is Ukraine.
However, the balance account code can be maintained even in other countries.
Description
Specify a suitable description for the account class.
3.2.24 Maintaining Notice Preferences
You can specify the notice preferences for the withdrawal of amount through the ‘Notice
Preferences’ screen. Click ‘Notice’ in the ‘Account Class Maintenance’ screen.
The ‘Notice Preferences’ screen is displayed as follows:
The following fields are displayed in this screen:

Account Class – The unique code assigned to the account class is displayed

Description – A short description of the account class is displayed
The following are the notice preferences that you can specify for an account class:
Advance Interest
Check this field to levy the advance interest on the account class.
Note the following:

The customer of the account class is liable to pay this interest in case he/she fails to
provide the required notice to the bank.

The system deducts the advance interest from the credit Interest earned by the customer
of the account class on his/her credit balance in the account.
3-48
Monthly Free Amount
Specify the amount that a customer of the account class can withdraw per calendar month from
his/her savings account without being liable to pay advance interest.
Notice Days
Specify the number of days before which a customer of the account class should notify the bank if
he/she wants to withdraw an amount more than the ‘Free Amount’ from his/her account.
Validity Period
Specify the notice validity period in number of days. During this period, a customer of the account
class can do the withdrawal of the amount for which he/she notified the bank.
3.2.25 Maintaining Account Class Transfer
Oracle FLEXCUBE facilitates the change of account class at the customer account level without
changing the customer account number. Depending on the destination account class, system
defaults the reporting GL lines and IC related values. The account class transfer can be initiated
through the ‘Account Class Transfer Maintenance’ screen.
You can invoke the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen by typing ‘STDACTFR’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
3-49
The following details are maintained here:
Branch Code
The current branch is defaulted here.
Account
Select the account number which requires an account class transfer, from the adjoining option
list. This adjoining option list displays all valid accounts maintained at the account class level.
Old Account Class
The account class to which the selected customer account belongs is defaulted here.
Currency
The currency of the selected customer account is defaulted here.
Account Class
Select the new account class to which the customer account has to be transferred, from the
adjoining option list. This adjoining option list displays all valid account class. When the account
class is selected, the system checks whether the new account class is a valid one or not.
Click the ‘Default’ button to generate default parameters.
If the old and new account class are of different type, then the system will display the following
Error Message on Save:
Old and new A/c class belongs to different a/c class types
Failed to Process the Request
Click ‘Ok’ to reset Account Class parameters.
If the old and new account class are of same type, then the system will display the following
Override Message:
Provisioning details should be manually modified, if required
Click ‘Accept’ if you wish to continue. The system will display the following Information Message:
Request Successfully Processed
Click ‘Ok’ to continue. The following GL details are defaulted based on the values maintained at
the Account Class level:

Status
3-50

Credit

Debit
Effective Date
The effective date of account class transfer can be based on either next liquidation cycle or
effective value date.
Next Liquidation Cycle
Check this box to indicate that the account class transfer should be effective from the earliest
liquidation date of the products mapped to the account.
Effective Date
Select the effective date for account class transfer from the adjoining calendar.
System displays an error message in the following conditions:

If the specified date coincides with a holiday

If the effective date is not provided and the transfer is based on actual date

If the selected customer account has an unprocessed record
GL Details
The reporting GL details of the account selected is defaulted here when you click ‘Default’ button.
Preferences
You can specify preferences for your account here.
Cheque Book
Check this box if you need a cheque book to be issued for your account.
Passbook
Check this box if you need a passbook to be issued for your account.
ATM
Check this box if you need to avail an ATM facility for your account.
Status Change Automatic
Check this box if you need automatic status change for your account.‘
3-51
3.2.25.1
Auxiliary’ Tab
Specify the auxiliary details by clicking ‘Auxiliary’ tab in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen.
Cheque Book Preferences
Maintain the following cheque book preferences if you have opted for a cheque book for your
account in the ‘Main’ tab.
Auto Re-order Cheque Required
Check this box to automatically reorder cheque books for all accounts belonging to this account
class.
Reorder Cheque Level
Specify the level at which you need a cheque book for the account.
Reorder Number Of Leaves
Specify the number of cheque leaves you need in the reordered cheque book.
Cheque Book Name 1
Specify the name used for opening savings account A1. This name will be printed on the cheque
book and will be used for all cheque transactions.
Cheque Book Name 2
Specify the name if you need to enter the name of the joint account holder on the cheque book, if
the customer account is joint operations account.
3-52
ATM Preference
You can maintain the following parameter if the ATM box is checked in the Main screen.
Atm Account No
Specify the valid ATM account number that should be linked to the new account class.
Daily Amount Limit
Specify the daily limit for the amount that can be withdrawn from the ATM.
Daily Amount Count
Specify the daily count for the amount that can be withdrawn from the ATM.
Options
You can maintain the following parameters for your account here.
Lodgement Book
Check this box if you need a lodgement book to be issued for the account.
Consolidated Cert. Reqd
Check this box if you need a consolidated certificate to be issued for the account.
Back Period Entry Allowed
Check this box if you need back period entries for the account.
Referral Required
Check this box if you need a referral check for your account.
Track Receivable
Check this box if you prefer to track the receivables for the account.
Remarks
Specify the reason for the account class change.
Processed Status
System displays the status of account class transfer here. The drop-down list displays the
following options:

Unprocessed–This status is defaulted till the account class transfer is effective.

Processed–This status is defaulted when the account class transfer is effective.
3-53
3.2.25.2
Maintaining IC Special Conditions
You can maintain the interest and consolidated charges of the account class in the ‘IC Special
Conditions Maintenance’ screen. The system would generate the details by default. You can
manually maintain the products if IC special condition is applicable for this account-account class
combination.
Click ‘Interest’ button in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen to invoke ‘IC Special Conditions
Maintenance’ screen.
The following details are captured here:
Branch Code
The current branch code is defaulted here.
Calculation Account
Select the valid customer account number for calculation from the adjoining option list.
Interest Booking Account
Select the valid customer account number from the adjoining option list.
Interest Start Date
Select to indicate the effective date to generate interest from the adjoining calendar.
3-54
Interest Booking Branch
Select to indicate valid Branch for calculating the interest from the adjoining option list.
Interest Statement
Check this box to generate the interest statement.
Charge Booking Account
Select the valid customer account number for booking the charge from the adjoining option list.
Charge Start Date
Specify to indicate the effective date to generate charges from the adjoining calendar.
Charge Booking Branch
Select to indicate the valid Branch from the option list, for calculating the charge.
Dr Cr Advices
Check this box to generate debit and credit related advices.
Consolidated Account
Select the valid account number from the adjoining option list.
Consolidated charge bank
Select the valid bank from the adjoining option list.
Product Details
You can specify product details for your account here.
Product Code
Select the valid product code from the adjoining option list.
UDE Currency
The system generates the user defined currency type maintained at ‘Interest Product Preference’
level.
Waive
Check this box if you need to waive of interest or charges defined for the selected interest product
at the Interest Product Preference level.
3-55
Generate UDE Change Advice
Check this box if you need to generate advice for change in values of the User Data elements for
the account.
Open
Check this box if you need to apply the selected interest product for the account.
3.2.25.3
Maintaining Account Level Charges Conditions
Click ‘Charges’ button in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen to invoke ‘Account level charges
conditions’ screen.
The following details are captured here:
Account Details
You can maintain the account details here.
Branch Code
The current branch code is defaulted here.
Account
The system generates the account number maintained in the ‘Main’ screen of ‘Account Class
Transfer’.
3-56
Product Detail
You can specify the parameters related to product here.
Product Code
Select a valid product code from the adjoining option list.
UDE Currency
The system generates the user defined currency type defined for the selected charges product.
Minimum
Specify the minimum charge that can be applied for the account.
Maximum
Specify the maximum charge that can be applied for the account.
Free Items
Specify to indicate the number of items on which the charges are not levied.
Waive Charges
Check this box if you need to waive the charges defined for the selected charges product at the
account level.
Open
Check this box if you need to apply the selected charges product for the account.
Slab Amount
You can specify the parameters related to slab amount here. You can add additional rows by
clicking the ‘+’ button and delete rows by clicking ‘-’ button.
Slab Amount
Specify an amount slab for the charges maintained at the account level. Rate will be applied for
the amounts less than or equal to the amount slab.
Charge Amount
Specify the charge amount applied for the selected product at the account.
Rate
Specify the rate to be applied for the charges maintained at the account level.
3-57
3.2.25.4
Maintaining Account Level Consolidated Charges Conditions
Click ‘Consolidated Charges’ button in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen to invoke ‘Account
Level Consolidated Charges Conditions’ screen.
The following details are captured here:
Account Details
You can maintain the account details for an account here.
Branch Code
The current branch code is defaulted here.
Account
The system generates the account number maintained in the ‘Main’ screen of ‘Account Class
Transfer’.
Product Details
You can specify product details for your account here.
Product Code
Select a valid product code from the adjoining option list.
Currency
The system generates the user defined currency type defined for the selected consolidated
charges product.
Minimum
Specify the minimum consolidated charges that can be applied for the account.
3-58
Maximum
Specify the maximum consolidated charges that can be applied for the account.
Open
Check this box if you need to apply the selected consolidated charges product for the account.
Waive Charges
Check this box if you need to waive the consolidated charges defined for the selected
consolidated charges product.
Discount
You can specify discount details for the consolidated charges applied for the account.
Discount Percentage
Specify percentage of the amount to be discounted from the computed consolidated charges.
Discount Amount
Specify a flat amount to be discounted from the computed consolidated charges.
3.2.25.5
Specifying Statement Details
Click ‘Statement’ button in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen to invoke ‘Statement’ screen.
Specify the following parameters for each of the valid account type.
3-59
Primary A/c Statement
You can generate account statement periodically for primary account type.
Type
Select the statement type to be generated from the options. The following values are available for
selection:

None–Select this option if you do not need an account statement.

Summary–Select this option if you need a brief account statement.

Detailed–Select this option if you need a detailed account statement.
Cycle
Select the frequency to generate statement, from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays
the following values:

Annual–Select this option if you need to generate the statement annually.

Semi Annual–Select this option if you need to generate the statement half yearly.

Quarterly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement quarterly.

Monthly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement monthly.

Fortnightly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement fortnightly.

Weekly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement weekly.

Daily–Select this option if you need to generate the statement daily.
On
Select a month, a date or a day to generate statement from the adjoining drop-down list. The
drop-down list displays following values:

Displays names of the months when Annual, Semi Annual, and Quarterly are selected at
the ‘Cycle’ level

Displays numbers from 1 to 31 when Monthly is selected at the ‘Cycle’ level

Displays names of the week days when Fortnightly and Weekly are selected at the
‘Cycle’ level

Displays a blank list when Daily is selected at the ‘Cycle’ level
Secondary A/c Statement
You can generate account statement periodically for secondary account type.
3-60
Type
Select the statement type to be generated from the options. The following values are available for
selection:

None–Select this option if you do not need an account statement.

Summary–Select this option if you need a brief account statement.

Detailed–Select this option if you need a detailed account statement.
Cycle
Select the frequency to generate statement, from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays
the following values:

Annual–Select this option if you need to generate the statement annually.

Semi Annual–Select this option if you need to generate the statement half yearly.

Quarterly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement quarterly.

Monthly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement monthly.

Fortnightly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement fortnightly.

Weekly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement weekly.

Daily–Select this option if you need to generate the statement daily.
On
Select a month, a date or a day to generate statement from the adjoining drop-down list. The
drop-down list displays following values:

Displays names of the months when Annual, Semi Annual, and Quarterly are selected at
the ‘Cycle’ level

Displays numbers from 1 to 31 when Monthly is selected at the ‘Cycle’ level

Displays names of the week days when Fortnightly and Weekly are selected at the
‘Cycle’ level

Displays a blank list when Daily is selected at the ‘Cycle’ level
Tertiary A/c Statement
You can generate account statement periodically for tertiary account type.
Type
Select the statement type to be generated from the options. The following values are available for
selection:

None–Select this option if you do not need an account statement.

Summary–Select this option if you need a brief account statement.
3-61

Detailed–Select this option if you need a detailed account statement.
Cycle
Select the frequency to generate statement, from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays
the following values:

Annual–Select this option if you need to generate the statement annually.

Semi Annual–Select this option if you need to generate the statement half yearly.

Quarterly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement quarterly.

Monthly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement monthly.

Fortnightly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement fortnightly.

Weekly–Select this option if you need to generate the statement weekly.

Daily–Select this option if you need to generate the statement daily.
On
Select a month, a date or a day to generate statement from the adjoining drop-down list. The
drop-down list displays following values:

Displays names of the months when Annual, Semi Annual, and Quarterly are selected at
the ‘Cycle’ level

Displays numbers from 1 to 31 when Monthly is selected at the ‘Cycle’ level

Displays names of the week days when Fortnightly and Weekly are selected at the
‘Cycle’ level

Displays a blank list when Daily is selected at the ‘Cycle’ level
Exclude Same Day Reversal trns from stmt
Check this box to exclude details of the transactions reversed on the same day from the
generated statement.
3.2.25.6
Maintaining MIS Details
Click ‘MIS’ button in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen to invoke ‘Management Information
System’ screen.
3-62
The screen is as shown below:
All the parameters are defaulted here. You can change the values if needed. The following
parameters are maintained:
Branch Code
The current branch code is defaulted here.
Account No
The system generates the account number maintained in the ‘Main’ screen of ‘Account Class
Transfer’.
MIS Group
Select a valid MIS group from the adjoining option list.
Link to Group
Check this box if you need to link MIS group to the account. Any changes to the MIS group would
be automatically applied to the linked account.
Ref Rate Code
Specify a valid reference rate code for the account.
3-63
Calculation Method
Select a method to calculate the rate from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays the
following values:

30(Euro)/360

30(US)/360

Actual/360

LBL_30_EURO_363

30(US)/365

Actual/365
Ref Rate Code
Select a valid reference type from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

Fixed–Select this option if you need a fixed reference rate for the account.

Floating Automatic–Select this option if you need to apply the reference rate maintained
at the account level.
Ref Spread
Specify the reference spread for the account.
Rate Flag
Select a valid rate flag from the options. The following values are available for selection:

Pool Code–Select this option if you need to apply the rate maintained for the pool to
which the account belongs.

Contract Level– Select this option if you need to apply the rate maintained at contract
level.
Pool Code
Select a valid pool code to which the account class belongs, from the adjoining option list.
Reference Rate
Select a valid reference rate from the adjoining option list.
Transaction MIS Code
The system generates transaction type of MIS code from the Account Class level. You can select
a valid MIS code from the adjoining option list, if needed.
3-64
Composite MIS Codes
The system generates composite type of MIS code from the Customer Maintenance level. You
can select a valid MIS code from the adjoining option list, if needed.
Cost Codes
The system generates cost codes from the Account Class level. You can select a valid cost code
from the adjoining option list, if needed.
3.2.25.7
Maintaining Account Status
Click ‘Account Status’ button in the ‘Account Class Transfer’ screen to invoke ‘Account Status’
screen.
All the parameters are defaulted here. You can change the values, if needed. The following
parameters are maintained
Account
You can maintain account details for your account here.
Branch Code
The current branch code is defaulted here.
Account
The system generates the account number maintained in the ‘Main’ screen of ‘Account Class
Transfer’.
3-65
Account Status
You can maintain account status details for your account here.
Status
The current account status is defaulted here. You can select a valid account status from the
adjoining option list, if needed.
Account class transfer is processed only if the account status is ‘NORM’.
Description
The description of the account status is defaulted here.
GL Lines
You can maintain the credit and debit details of the general ledger reporting lines for your account
here.
Credit
The GL code related to credit is defaulted here. You can select a valid GL code from the adjoining
option list, if needed.
Debit
The GL code related to debit is defaulted here. You can select a valid GL code from the adjoining
option list, if needed.
HO Lines
You can maintain the credit and debit details of the Head Office reporting lines for your account
here.
Credit
The line code related to credit is defaulted here. You can select a valid line code from the
adjoining option list, if needed.
Debit
The line code related to debit is defaulted here. You can select a valid line code from the
adjoining option list, if needed.
CB Lines
You can maintain the credit and debit details of the Central Bank reporting lines for your account
here.
3-66
Credit
The line code related to credit is defaulted here. You can select a valid line code from the
adjoining option list, if needed.
Debit
The line code related to debit is defaulted here. You can select a valid line code from the
adjoining option list, if needed.
3.2.26 Processing Account Class Transfer
Oracle FLEXCUBE facilitates the change of account class at the customer level without changing
the customer account number. Depending on the destination account class, system defaults
reports the reporting GL lines and IC related values.
3.2.26.1
Processing EOD Batch
During IC EOD process, system considers interest accrual for the back value dated transactions
carried out prior to account class transfer, and computes the interest from the effective date of
transfer based on new account class values. If the value date of the back value transaction is
before the effective date of transfer, then the system does not compute interest for the period
between value date and effective date.
System does not process IC calculation of back valued UDE change, back value dated
transaction, CIF type change and bulk change of the old account class.
3.2.26.2
Processing BOD Batch
During BOD process, system initiates the IC online liquidation of interest accrued on various
products for all the customer accounts in the account class, till the effective date of account class
transfer. Using gateway infrastructure, system authorizes and changes the account class based
on the parameters maintained at the account class transfer level. However, GL balance of the
accounts processed for account class transfer would be considered for the next day EOC.
Note the following:

Transfer of the account class would be effective only after the liquidation of customer
accounts.

Error log is written for the customer account which has failed in the account class
transfer.
When account class transfer maintenance is saved, the system will enforce restriction and display
an error message in following conditions:

If one of the mask components of the customer account is Account class

If dual-currency is enabled for the old account class
3-67

If the account is already linked in ILM structure

If the old account class is deposit type

If the new account class has customer or currency restriction on the selected customer
and account currency respectively
3.2.27 Viewing Account Class Transfer
You can view a summary of Account Class Transfer maintained at the ‘Account Class Transfer’
level using ‘Account Class Transfer’ summary screen. You can invoke the ‘Account Class
Transfer’ summary screen by typing ‘STSACTFR’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can view records based on any or all of the following criteria:
Authorization Status
You can view records based on the authorization status of the account class transfer by selecting
an option from the adjoining drop-down list. This list provides the following options:

Authorised–Select this option if the account class transfer is authorised.

Unauthorised–Select this option if the account class transfer is unauthorised.
3-68
Branch Code
Select a valid branch code if you need to view records based on the branch code of the account.
Old Account Class
Select a valid account class if you need to view records based on the account class from which
the account was transferred, from the adjoining option list.
Next Liquidation Cycle
Check this box if you need to view records based on status of liquidation cycle.
Record Status
You can view records based on the record status of the account class transfer by selecting an
option from the adjoining drop-down list. This list provides the following options:

Open–Select this option if the account class transfer is not effective.

Closed–Select this option if the account class transfer is effective.
Account Class
Select a valid account class if you need to view records based on the account class to which the
account is transferred, from the adjoining option list.
Account
Select a valid account number if you need to view records based on the account class for which
the account class transfer is applied from the adjoining option list.
Click ‘Search’ button. The system identifies all records satisfying the specified criteria and
displays the following details for each one of them:

Authorization Status

Record Status

Branch Code

Account Class

Old Account Class

Account

Next Liquidation Cycle

Effective Date
3.2.28 Maintaining Narratives
The ‘Narrative Maintenance’ screen allows you to define the format of a Detailed Account
Statement.
3-69
Invoke the ‘Narrative Maintenance’ screen, by typing ‘CSDSTNAR’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
If you are defining the details of a new record, choose new from the Actions Menu, or click new
icon from the toolbar. The ‘Narrative Maintenance’ screen is displayed without any details.
After you have entered all the details of a record, save the record using one of the following
methods:

Click Save icon in the toolbar

Select Save from the Actions Menu
While maintaining narratives, if you choose the narrative type for a module the prompt codes
maintained for this module are displayed. You can choose the relevant prompt code from the
option list.
For the FT module, the prompt codes can be the following:

FT-EVENTDESC

FT-USERREFNO
For the above prompt codes you have to enter the descriptions in the desired language. For
instance the description for FT-EVENTDESC can be maintained as EVENT DESCRIPTION in the
English language.
3-70
The Account statement for the above maintenance will look like EVENT DESCRIPTION –
REVERSAL, where reversal is the actual event happening. The word REVERSAL itself is picked
up from the same screen for Event type of narratives.
The same logic applies to the other type of narratives
3.2.29 Maintaining Customer Instruction Details
Instructions Maintenance screen allows users to maintain instructions for customers with the
current branch as the local branch.
Invoke this screen, by typing ‘CSDINSTR’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Customer Number
Specify the required Customer Number from the list of values maintained.
Customer Name
The name of the customer is displayed here.
Instruction Id
Unique ID for the instruction is displayed here.
Instruction Date
Specify the date on which the instruction is added. You can select the date from the adjoining
calendar.
3-71
Instruction Expiry Date
Specify the date on which the instruction will expire. You can select the date from the adjoining
calendar.
Instruction Description
Specify the description of the Actual Instruction.
3.2.29.1
Viewing Customer Instructions
All the instructions maintained in the Instructions Maintenance screen can be viewed in the
Customer Instructions View screen. To invoke this screen, specify the Customer number,
Contract reference number or Account number and press the hotkey F6.
If F6 is pressed form customer account number field, system fetches all the instructions of
customer of the selected customer account. If F6 is pressed from a contract reference number
field, system fetches all the instructions of the counterparty of the contract. If F6 is pressed form
customer field, system fetches all the instructions of customer of the selected customer.
The Customer Instruction View screen will be launched with all the instructions maintained for the
customer.
The following fields can be viewed in this screen:

Customer Number

Customer Name

Instruction Id

Instruction Date

Instruction Expiry Date
3-72

3.2.29.2
Instruction Description
Viewing the Instructions Summary
You can view the summary of instructions in the ‘Instructions Summary’ screen. It displays the
status of the records maintained, whether it is authorized, unauthorized or rejected.
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘CSSINSTR’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking on the adjoining arrow button.
To view the summary of instructions, you can perform a search based on any of the following.
Authorisation Status
Select the authorisation status of the instruction as:

Authorised

Unauthorised
Record Status
Select the record status of the instruction as:

Open
3-73

Closed
Customer number
Select a Customer number from the list to view the instructions maintained for that customer. The
following details of the record get displayed.

Authorization Status

Record Status

Instruction Details
This facility is generic for all the screens, but you can make modifications for these
instructions.
3.2.30 Maintaining Lead Details
You can capture details of products and offers that are rendered to a customer and the response
of the customer to the same in the ‘Lead Input’ screen. To invoke this screen, type ‘STDLEDMT’,
in the field at the top right corner of the Application toolbar and click the adjoining arrow button.
Specify the following details:
Lead Id
The system displays the lead identification number.
3-74
Customer No
Specify the customer identification number whose request is being maintained. The adjoining
option displays all the customer numbers that are maintained in the system. You can choose the
appropriate one.
E-mail
The system will display the customer’s email address based on the customer number selected.
Telephone
The system will display the customer’s contact number based on the customer number selected.
First Name
The system will display the customer’s first name based on the customer number selected.
Last Name
The system will display the customer’s last name based on the customer number selected.
Address 1, 2, 3, and 4
Specify the address line 1, 2, 3, and 4.
Areas of Interest
Specify the area in which the customer is having interest.
Remarks
Specify any additional information, if any.
3.2.30.1
Product Tab
Specify the product details:
Product Code
Specify the product code which is to be associated to the customer. The adjoining option list
displays all the product code that are maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate
one.
Product Description
The system displays a brief description of the product.
Interested Flag
Check this box to indicate that the product that is selected should be included in the lead creation.
3-75
3.2.30.2
Offer Tab
Specify the offer details:
Offer Code
Specify the offer code that is rendered to the customer. The adjoining option list displays all the
offer code that are maintained in the system. You can select the appropriate one.
Offer Description
The system displays a brief description of the offers that are offered to the customer.
Response
Choose the offer response from the drop-down. The options available are:

Accepted

Rejected

Interested

Not interested

Tell a friend
3-76
3.2.31 Maintaining Service Request Input Details
You can maintain the customer and non-customer’s request\complaints in the ‘Service Request
Input’ screen. To invoke this screen, type ‘STDSRQST’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
You need to maintain the following details:
Customer Details
Specify the following details:
Requestor Type
Select the type of requestor from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

Customer

Non- Customer
Customer No
Specify the customer identification number whose request is being maintained. The adjoining
option displays all the customer numbers that are maintained in the system. You can choose the
appropriate one. This field will be enabled only if the requestor type is selected as ‘Customer’.
Short Name
The system will display the customer’s short name based on the customer number selected.
3-77
Full Name
The system will display the customer’s full name based on the customer number selected.
Telephone
The system will display the customer’s contact number based on the customer number selected.
Mobile Number
The system will display the customer’s mobile number based on the customer number selected.
E-mail
The system will display the customer’s email address based on the customer number selected.
Subject
Specify the subject matter of the request\complaint.
Description
Specify the brief description of the request\complaint.
Service Details
Specify the following details:
Service Request Type
Select the service request type from the adjoining drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

Transactional

Non Transactional

Complaint
Service No
The system generates the service request number.
Branch Code
The system displays the branch
Account No
The system will display the customer’s account number based on the customer number selected.
3-78
Priority
Select the priority of the request\complaint from the drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

High

Medium

Low
Status
Select the status of the request\complaint from the drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

Open

Pending

Closed

Escalated
Nature
Select the nature of the request\complaint from the drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

Service

Sales
Criteria
Select the criteria of the request\complaint from the drop-down list. This list displays the following
values:

Enquiry

Channel

Product

Application

Maintenance
Contact Date
Specify the date on when the request or compliant is made.
Target date
Specify the date on when the request or compliant is to be closed.
3-79
Activation Date
Specify the date on when the request or compliant is activated.
3.2.31.1
Specifying Lead Details
You can maintain both the customers and non –customer details in the ‘Lead Input‘ screen by
clicking ‘Lead’ button in the ‘Service Request Input’ screen. The following screen will be
displayed.
For more details on the Lead Input screen, refer the ‘Maintaining Lead Details’ section of this user
manual.
3.2.32 Viewing Service Request Details
You can view the summary of service request details in the ‘Service Request’ screen. To invoke
this screen, type ‘STSSRQST’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and
click on the adjoining arrow button.
3-80
The screen is as shown below:
You can query on records based on any one or all of the following criteria:

Authorization Status

Record Status

Service No

Service Request Type

Customer No

Account No

Branch Code

Requestor Type

Status

Contact date

Target Date

Telephone
Click ‘Search’ button. The system identifies all records satisfying the specified criteria and
displays the following details for each one of them:

Authorization Status
3-81

Record Status

Service No

Service Request Type

Customer No

Account No

Branch Code

Requestor Type

Status

Contact date

Target Date

Telephone
3.2.33 Maintaining Location Details
While maintaining Customer Information details through the CIF Maintenance screen, in addition
to indicating the name of the country in which your customer resides you can also choose to
specify the name of the region or locality where your customer stays. For instance, Silas Marner,
a customer of your bank is a Londoner, Great Britain is his country of residence. He lives in the
northern part of London; therefore North London becomes the location where he resides.
Location codes, along with a brief description of the locality can be maintained through the
‘Location Details’ maintenance screen.
3-82
Invoke the ‘Location Maintenance’ screen, by typing ‘STDCULOC’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Location Code
You can capture a unique three-character code to identify the locality where the customer
resides.
While maintaining customer information details and associating a location code with a
Customer and Country Code combination, a list of all the valid location codes you have
maintained in this screen will be available in the option list for the Location Code field. You can
select the appropriate code.
Description
You can also associate a brief description with the location code. This description is for
information purposes only and will not be printed on any customer correspondence.
While maintaining the Customer Short Name in the ‘CIF Details’ screen the system
automatically appends the Location code to the customer short name when you associate the
appropriate Location Code with the Customer Code.
Church Tax percentage
Specify the church tax percentage to be charged for customers belonging to the specified
location..
The church tax percentage will vary for each state in Germany.
3-83
3.2.34 Capturing Algorithm Details in Oracle FLEXCUBE
In Oracle FLEXCUBE, you can choose to generate check-digits for Customer Accounts based on
the algorithm of your choice. You can define algorithms of your choice through the ‘Algorithm
Maintenance’ screen. Invoke this screen by typing ‘CSDALGMT’ in the field at the top right corner
of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
In this screen, you should specify the following details:

The Name of the Algorithm. This will uniquely identify the algorithm in Oracle FLEXCUBE

A brief description of the algorithm
After you capture the details of a new algorithm you must ‘write’ the algorithm through the
‘Algorithm Procedure Generation’ screen
3.2.34.1
Generating Procedure for Algorithm
For every algorithm that you define through the ‘Algorithm Maintenance’ screen must write the
algorithm generation rule through the ‘Algorithm Generation Input’ screen.
Invoke this screen by typing ‘CSDALGGN’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
3-84
The screen is as shown below:
Since the access to this screen is restricted to only a few authorized users at your branch level,
you will be allowed to invoke the screen only if you have the requisite rights.
In this screen, you can specify:

The name of the algorithm for which you are writing the algorithm generation rule. A list of
all the algorithms you have maintained through the ‘Algorithm Maintenance’ screen is
displayed. You can select the appropriate

The Function Type, which specifies the type of the function using the algorithm. The
options available are:

Validation - indicates that the function is using the algorithm to validate the ‘input’
string. For all such functions, the input string is validated as being True or False
depending upon whether the validation was a success or a failure

Check Digit Generation - indicates that the function is used for the generation of
check digit using the algorithm. Such functions will take the input string without the
check digit and return the check digit
You must enter the algorithm rule in the form of PL/SQL code. After writing the PL/SQL code,
click ‘Execute’ button to compile the code. The algorithm rule is validated by the system and the
success or failure message is shown in the Error editor. Click ‘Errors’ button to view the errors.
If any checks fail, you must alter the statement so that the validation can be made successfully.
The algorithm is generated on Authorization of the rule.
3-85
Click the ‘Clear’ button, the Algorithm Rule editor and the Error editor will be cleared for you to
enter a new rule in the field.
The System provides two pre-defined key elements both for Check Digit Generation and
Validation type of algorithms. They are:

l_branch_code

l_customer_no
You will not be allowed to enter the following keywords in an Algorithm Rule:

ROLLBACK

COMMIT

DECLARE

DELETE

UPDATE

INSERT
Once defined, you will not be allowed to unlock and amend the following fields:

Algorithm Rule

Algorithm Description

Function Type
You can refer the Clearing user manual for more information
3.2.35 Maintaining Turnover Limits
You can maintain turnover limits for a given period of time using the ‘Turnover Limit Maintenance’
screen. You can attach these limits to an account class and thereby track the turnover on all
accounts under the account class.
You can invoke the ‘Turnover Limit Maintenance’ screen by typing ‘STDTOLMT’ in the field at the
top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking on the adjoining arrow button.
3-86
The screen is as shown below:
Here, you need to specify the following details.
Limit Code
Specify a unique code used to identify turnover limit.
Description
Specify a brief description associated with the turnover limit.
Period Details
You can specify the following details pertaining to the period for limit application.
Period Code
Specify a unique code to identify the financial period for which you wish to maintain turnover
limits.
3-87
Start Date
Specify the start date of the financial period, using the adjoining calendar.
End Date
Specify the end date of the financial period, using the adjoining calendar.
You can maintain multiple period codes. However, the periods cannot overlap.
Limit Amount Details
You can specify the following details pertaining limits applicable on the period code.
Limit Currency
Specify the currency of the limit amount. This adjoining option list displays all valid currency
codes maintained in the system. You can choose the appropriate one.
Limit Amount
Specify the limit amount applicable of the financial period.
Note the following:
3.3

You can increase or decrease the maximum turnover limit as part of record modification.
The modified limits will be applicable only for subsequent transactions.

Unutilized limit amount does not get carried forward to the next period.
Maintaining Deposits Instructions
You can maintain deposits instructions for auto created deposits. The values you specify here will
override the parameters you have maintained in the Account Class maintenance. Invoke the
‘Deposits Instruction’ screen from the Application Browser to maintain the deposits instructions
specifically for the auto created deposits. To invoke this screen type ‘ICCINSTR’ in the field at
the top right corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
3-88
The screen is as shown below:
You can set the terms and a condition for a deposit as follows:

Account Number – This is the account number of the deposit

Account Class – This is the account class to which the account is linked

Customer Number – The customer for whom you are maintaining the deposit instructions.

Sweep to Account – Indicate the account to which the sweep is carried out

Amount – This is the deposit amount

Minimum Required Balance – The minimum balance indicates that only the amounts
above this limit will be used for auto creating deposits

Source Code – The code assigned for the sweep

External Reference Number

Start Date – The instructions will be valid from this date

Branch Code – The branch code of the branch which is to be associated with the account

Sequence Number – The system generated sequence number for the instruction you are
maintaining

Currency Code - The Currency of the particular account

Deposit Currency – The currency in which the deposit is made

Tenor – The tenor for the deposits that are opened under an account class

Sweep Multiple of – The sweep can only be in multiples of the sweep specified

Retry Till Date – The instructions specified will be invalid after this date. Any failed
sweeps after this date will not be picked up for processing the next day.

3-89
Financial Institution Type Maintenance Screen
You can invoke the ‘Static Type Maintenance’ screen by typing ‘CODSTTYP’ in the field at the
top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can specify the following:
Type
Select the ‘Financial Institution Types’ from the adjoining option list.
Description
Specify the description as ‘List of Financial Institution Type’.
Field Value
Specify the financial institution type name.
Code
Specify the financial institution type code.
Exemption Code Maintenance Screen
You can invoke the ‘Static Type Maintenance’ screen by typing ‘CODSTTYP’ in the field at the
top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
3-90
You can specify the following:
Type
Select the ‘Exemption Codes’ from the adjoining option list.
Description
Specify the description as ‘List of Exemption Codes’.
Field Value
Specify the exemption name.
Code
Specify the exemption code.
3-91
4.
4.1
Processing Referrals in Oracle FLEXCUBE
Introduction
Referral refers to the process of handling customer transactions, which force the accounts
involved in such a transaction to exceed the overdraft limit. Examples of typical transactions,
which force an account to move into overdraft, are Payment and Collections, Funds Transfers,
Standing Instructions or Clearing transactions. In Oracle FLEXCUBE, if an account involved in a
transaction moves into overdraft, it is sent to the Referral Queue.
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STSREFQU’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
In this screen the following details of the account are displayed:

The account Branch and Branch code

The Account Number

The Name of the customer who holds the account

The Current Balance in the account. This includes the aggregate of debit, credit,
uncollected, unauthorized, authorized and unposted transactions

The amount available for withdraw

The overdraft limit of the account. This is inclusive of the sub-limit

The Credit Rating or the credit worthiness of the account holder
4-1
A charge, fee or interest debited to the customer account will not be referred to the Referral
Queue
Using the Referral Queue, you can view details of all transactions processed during the day due
to which the account has moved into overdraft. For example, Silas Marner’s savings account has
a balance of 1000 Euro (with no O/D facility). There are five checks of 300 Euro each drawn on
the account on the same day. On double clicking on Silas Marner’s account number in the
Referral Queue, the details of all five checks will be displayed for your perusal in the Referral
screen.
You can invoke this screen by typing ‘STDREFQU’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You will be able to view the following details about the entries which have been posted and those
that are not to post:

The Posting Date

The Contract Ref No/DD Reference Number

A brief description about the Referral

The amount, which is to be debited from the customer account

Pay

Un pay
4-2
The default option is to approve (Pay) the check/DD amount. On occasion you may want to
‘unpay’ or reject a check/DD. You will be allowed to levy charges both for approving as well as
recalling/rejecting checks. There are no limits on the charges for recalling a check but you can
levy approval charges for a maximum of three transactions only. The charges for each
accept/reject are computed on the basis of the IC Charge Rule linked to the customer account.
You will not be allowed to recall or unpay future dated transactions (typically future dated
fund transfers or standing orders). The transaction will be initiated and entries posted passed only
if the referral decision is to pay.
Each time you choose to reject a transaction you will have to indicate the reason for rejecting the
transaction. A list of Reason Codes is available in the option list. You can select the appropriate.
A transaction is considered for charging only if the Waive Charge option has not been enabled for
a particular Reject Code. You can enable the option if the charge is to be waived.
4.1.1 Maintenance Required for Referral Processing
For the successful processing of referrals in Oracle FLEXCUBE, you will need to maintain the
following details.
4.1.1.1 Enabling Referral Required Option
You will need to enable the Referral Required option in the following maintenance screens:

Customer Account Class Maintenance - Enabling this option would indicate whether a
referral check should be performed on accounts belonging to the account class.
Consequently, the system checks the available balance (not the current balance) while
performing the referral checks for all transactions involving the account.

Customer Accounts Maintenance - The Referral Required option is defaulted from the
account class linked to the account. However, you can change it for a specific account. If
an account is marked for referral, the details of transactions resulting in the account
moving into Overdraft will be referred to the Referral Queue.

Product Preferences screens of the Funds Transfer, Standing Instructions, Payment
and Collections modules and the Product Definition screen of the Clearing module.
While maintaining the details of an FT. SI, PC or CG product you can indicate whether
transactions involving the product need to be considered for referral checks. Enabling this
option indicates whether the product needs to be considered for referral. If a product is
marked for referral, the details of transactions resulting in the account (involved in the
transaction) moving into Overdraft will be sent to the Referral Queue.
4.1.1.2 Specifying Referral Cut-off Time
In branch parameter, you have to specify the referral cut-off time for accepting / rejecting
transactions in the referral queue.
In case a transaction is rejected from the referral queue after the cut-off time then system
displays the following override message:
4-3
‘Rejected after cut off time`
Transactions are accepted into the Referral Queue even after cut-off time if account goes into
overdraft.
4.1.1.3 Processing the Referral Batch
While marking EOTI, the system checks if any unprocessed referral transactions exist in the
referral queue. If so, the system will display an error message. However, if you check the ‘Auto
Approval of Referral Transaction’ box in the ‘Branch Parameters Preferences’ screen, system will
not perform the referral queue check.
During the referral batch process, all the unprocessed transactions are fetched from the referral
queue. The batch will then reject or pay transactions based on the ‘pay’ or ‘un-pay’ checks in the
referral queue.
If you run the referral batch during EOD and if the ‘Auto Approval of Referral Transaction’ box is
checked in the ‘Branch Parameters Preferences’ screen, then the referral batch will fetch any
unprocessed transactions for which the ‘pay’ and ‘un-pay’ options are unchecked in the referral
queue. For such transactions, the system will check if the accounting entries are passed for the
contract or not.

If the entries are not passed, then the system liquidates the contracts.

If the entries are passed, then the system accepts the contracts and updates the IC
charge counter.
Note the following:

The referral batch should run only during the EOTI stage and not during the End Of
Financial Input (EOFI) stage.

It is possible for the referral batch to update the run status in the pending programs list.
4.1.1.4 Enabling Netting Required Option
If linked accounts are marked for referral you can choose to consolidate the balances in all the
linked accounts before performing the referral check. To process linked accounts which are
marked for referral you will need to enable the Netting Required option in the following screens:
4.1.1.5 Enabling Limit Maintenance Screen
Enabling this option indicates that the netting of balances is allowed for accounts linked to the
credit line. To pool balances across accounts you may need to link a common Credit Line across
accounts where balances are to be pooled. Therefore, you will need to indicate whether balances
for the credit line and the respective accounts should be netted. As a result, while performing the
limits check for accounting the system will take into consideration the collective balance across all
accounts linked to the line.
4-4
EXAMPLE
Let us assume that Silas Marner holds three accounts with your bank

SA0000121

SA0000122

SA0000123
All three are linked to the credit line SA_Pool. The credit utilization limit you have offered him is USD 10,000.
The Available Balance in each of the account is as follows:
SA0000121
SA0000122
SA0000123
Available Balance
USD 1000
USD 2500
EUR 3000
Debits due to transactions
processed today
- 9000
NA
NA
Sum of debits for today
- 8000
+ 2500
+ 3200 (in
USD)
Total Debit across accounts = - USD 2500 (8000 – 5700)
After pooling Mr. Marner still has a credit utilization limit of USD 7, 700 (10000 – 2300)
If you have defined temporary overdraft limits for the accounts, and the temporary OD limit forms
a part of the netting, the temporary OD limit will not be considered for netting.
Rules for Set off for principal in referrals
When customer accounts are linked for principal set-off, the Available Balance (summed for all
accounts in the arrangement) plus the Overdraft Limit (for the main account) and the Sub limit (for
the main account) minus the Total transactions received (on all accounts) is less than zero.
All transactions received are ‘referred’ even if a transaction is on an account, which has sufficient
credit balance to pay the transaction.
If an account is set for principal, it means that it is automatically set for interest pooling too.
However, if an account is marked only for interest set off the system does not perform the
principal set off for referral.
Account Limits sub-screen of the Customer Account Maintenance screen
The Netting Allowed option is defaulted from the Credit Line associated with the customer
account. If you change the default option the system displays an override message.
Liability Maintenance sub-screen of the Customer Information screen
4-5
The netting option is defaulted to the Liability Maintenance sub-screen of the Customer
Maintenance screen. This option is defaulted from the Liability Code (which is linked to the Credit
Line) that you associate with the CIF ID. If you change the default, the system displays an
override message.
4.1.1.6 Future-dated Funds Transfers (FT)
Entries are not passed for future dated FTs and SIs in case of insufficient funds. Such
transactions are moved to the Referral Queue for Approval (pay) / Rejection (un-pay). The pool
balance defined in the LM Structure Maintenance is the balance, which is considered for OD.
Status
If accounting entries have not been passed
Resulting Action
Accept – the accounting entries are passed and the IC Charge counter is updated.
Reject – No resulting action.
If you have not performed any action on the contract, the transaction is resubmitted for
processing the next day.
4.1.1.7 Standing Instructions (SI)
Standing instructions are sent to Queue when sufficient funds are not available in the customer’s
account
Status
If accounting entries have not been passed
Resulting Action
Accept - the accounting entries are passed and the IC Charge counter is updated
Reject – No resulting action
4.1.1.8 Payments and Collections (PC)
If you have enabled the Override Overdraft option as a preference while defining Outgoing
Payments or Incoming Collection products the transactions involving the products will be
processed regardless of the overdraft status. Else, such transactions will be sent to the Credit
Exception queue and to the Referral queue as well. Upon Accepting or Rejecting a transaction in
the Referral Queue, these transactions are processed in the same manner as any other
transaction in the Credit Exception queue.
4-6
For further details refer to the processing transactions in the Credit Exception Queue refer to the
Processing Credit Exceptions section in the Processing a Payment or Collection Transaction
chapter of the Payment and Collections manual.
4.1.1.9 Clearing (CG) Transactions
If the fund available in the customer account are insufficient, the clearing transaction is processed
(i.e., the relevant accounting entries are passed) and the transaction is sent to the Referral
Queue.
If the transaction is rejected, the entries are reversed. The status of the transaction is updated to
‘Dishonored’ in the clearing log. In case the transaction is accepted, no processing is required
apart from updating the charge counter.
If the account goes into overdraft, all processed transactions for the day with transaction code
marked for referral are moved to the Referral Queue. However, transactions which have already
been accepted will not be marked for referral again.
If a transaction is to be marked for referral, the transaction details are stored in a separate table.
The details in the referral screen are displayed from this table.
Note that transactions from Savings module will appear in the ‘Posted’ tab.
You can get accounting entries reversed or confirm for the overdrawn account using the ‘Intra
Day Batch Start’ screen. You can invoke this screen by typing ‘BADIDBAT’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Specify the following information.
Function
Specify ‘CSREFQPR’ or choose this value from the adjoining option list.
Click ‘OK’ button to run the batch.
4-7
5. Provisioning for Customer Accounts
5.1
Introduction
Your bank may wish to set up certain guidelines according to which provision must be made for
outstanding overdrafts on customer accounts.
For instance, it may be necessary to set the provisioning amount for an account in respect of
which there is an outstanding overdraft, based on the status of the account, as well as the
financial standing of the customers.
You might also wish to include exposure due to loans issued to a customer, as well as total
outstanding overdraft in all accounts of a customer, or a group of customers as a whole, and
assign the status of all loans issued to the group as well as all accounts under a group, as the
worst status among all loans and accounts, belonging to the group.
This chapter explains how you can use the system to perform the processes related to
provisioning for customer accounts.
In order to maintain provisioning guidelines, you must

Specify whether you wish to track the status of customer accounts and loan contracts at
a customer group/CIF level, or at the level of individual contracts or accounts, for your
branch.

Set up the categories under which you wish track exposure and specify the provisioning
percentages for each exposure category type

Maintain the logic according to which the exposure category would be arrived at, based
on the customer type, and the amount limits applicable for each customer type.

Set up classifications for considering the financial standing of customers, for the purpose
of status processing

Set up the customer groups for which you wish to track exposure as a whole

Set up rules for deriving the status of accounts for a group or CIF

Set up rules for deriving the provisioning amount, for accounts using an account class

Set up the frequency at which the provisioning batch would be executed, if the status
processing is done at group/CIF level
5.1.1 Specifying Basis for Status Processing
In the Branch Parameters, you can indicate the basis upon which status processing must be done
at the branch, for customer accounts as well as loan contracts.
Status processing can be done either at the level of individual contracts and accounts, or at a
customer group or CIF level.
5-1
5.1.1.1 Status Processing at Group/CIF Level
If you opt for group or CIF-level processing, it is done in two stages:

The worst status among all loan contracts and accounts under a specific customer group
or CIF is arrived at

All accounts and contracts involving the customer group or CIF are then moved to the
worst status that was arrived at. The individual status of the account and contract, apart
from the worst status being assigned, is also captured and displayed in the respective
account and contract screens.
5.1.1.2 Processing at Individual Contract/Account Level
If you opt for status processing at individual contract/account level, the status of each contract or
account would be assigned according to the status processing parameters that are operative for
the contract or account.
For details about the Branch Parameters screen, refer the Core Services user manual.
5.1.2 Setting up Customer Groups for Provisioning
You may wish to track exposure due to loans issued to a group of customers as a whole, and
assign the status of all loans issued to the group as the status of the loan with the worst status,
among those issued to the group.
You may similarly wish to include the exposure due to outstanding overdraft in respect of a group
of customer accounts as a whole, and assign the status of all customer accounts belonging to the
group as the status of the customer account with the worst status among the accounts and loans
belonging to the group.
You can set up such customer groups, for tracking exposure due to loans as well as overdraft
customer accounts, in the ‘Group Code Maintenance’ screen. Invoke this screen by typing
‘STDGRMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the
adjoining arrow button.
Each group code that you define is associated with an appropriate exposure category that must
be used to track exposure due to loans issued to customers in the group, as well as customer
accounts with outstanding overdrafts.
5-2
The exposure category for a group is either derived from the logic maintained in the Exposure
Type Category Linkage maintenance for the group type, or explicitly specified. If it is derived, it is
displayed in this screen, by the End of Day batch program. The type of the group indicates the
type of customers that belong to the group – retail, corporate, Charge Clearing or Tax. If no logic
has been maintained in the Exposure Type Category Linkage for the group type, you can indicate
the applicable exposure category for the group.
Group Code
When you maintain CIF details for customers, in the Customer Information Maintenance screen,
you can specify the customer group to which the customer belongs, for provisioning and status
processing. You must specify a group code defined for a group type that is the same as the
customer type, for instance, if the customer is a retail customer, you must specify a group defined
for retail customers.
Group Status
All loans and overdraft accounts issued to customers in the group will be assigned the same
status, which will be the status of the loan/overdraft account with the worst status among those
issued to customers in the group. The Group/CIF and the loan contracts and overdraft accounts
are all updated with this worst status if they have been marked for automatic status processing.
The individual status for the accounts and loan contracts (apart from assigning the worst status)
is also captured and displayed. In the Group Code Maintenance screen and the CIF
Maintenance screen, the status for the group is displayed, as well as the date since which the
current status came into effect.
For details about loan status processing and provisioning, consult the Loans user manual.
5.1.3 Setting up Customer Classifications for Status Processing
You can set up the different classifications under which the financial standing of the customer
would be considered, for status processing. You can set up these classifications in the ‘Customer
Classification Details’ screen. You must specify an appropriate classification code and
description.
You can invoke this screen, by typing ‘STDCCMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the
Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
For instance, you could set up the following classifications:

Good – for customers with no bad loans and no accounts with outstanding overdrafts

Unstable – for customers with a few bad loans and accounts with outstanding overdrafts

Not Good – for customers with many bad loans and accounts with outstanding overdrafts
5-3

Deteriorate – for customers with mostly bad loans and accounts with outstanding
overdrafts

Bad – for customers with only bad loans and accounts with outstanding overdrafts
Customer Classification
When you specify CIF details for a customer in the Customer Information Maintenance screen,
you can also specify the appropriate classification for the customer.
Description
Enter a description for the classification.
5.1.4 Setting up Exposure Categories
You can maintain the different categories under which you wish to track total exposure due to
loans issued to customers in customer groups or CIF’s, as well as due to total overdraft in
accounts belonging to customer groups or CIFs, for the purpose of ascertaining the amount of
provisioning required.
You can maintain such exposure categories in the ‘Exposure Category Maintenance’ screen, by
specifying the name of the exposure category, and a short description.
Invoke this screen by typing ‘LDDECMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can view the summary of the exposure categories in the ‘Exposure Category Maintenance
Summary’ screen.
5.1.4.1 Specifying Status-wise Provisioning Percentages for Each Exposure Category
After you have maintained exposure categories, you must maintain the appropriate provisioning
percentages to apply to each exposure category, for contracts as well as accounts in each of the
statuses. You must also maintain the applicable discount percentages. You can do this in the
‘Exposure Category Provisioning Percent Maintenance’ screen, where you can specify the
applicable provisioning percentage and discount percentage for each status.
5-4
Invoke this screen by typing ‘LDDPRVMN’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can view the summary of the provisioning details in the ‘Exposure Category Provisioning
Percent Maintenance’ Summary screen.
Invoke this screen by typing ‘LDSPRVMN’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
For contracts and accounts involving a customer whose exposure is being tracked under the
exposure category, the applicable provisioning percentage (as well as the discount percentage) is
picked up from this maintenance, if not specified at contract input (or in the case of accounts, in
the Customer Account Maintenance).
5-5
5.1.4.2 Specifying Logic for Deriving Exposure Category
After you have maintained exposure categories, you must also specify how the system would
derive the exposure category under which contracts and accounts must be tracked. The
exposure category can be derived from the following parameters:
Category Type
You may wish to track the exposure in respect of customers from different categories such as
retail or corporate, under different exposure categories.
Amount Limits
You may wish to specify an amount range within which the total exposure would be tracked, for
the customer or group.
In the ‘Exposure Category - Category Type Linkage’ screen, you can link the exposure category
to be used for tracking different customer category types and total exposure in respect of a
customer group.
Invoke this screen by typing ‘LDDETMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The screen is as shown below:
You can view the summary of the exposure category linkages in the ‘Exposure Category Category Type Linkage Summary’ screen.
5-6
Invoke this screen by typing ‘LDSETMNT’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Category Type
You must specify the customer category type, for which you wish to link the appropriate exposure
category type.
Basis Amount
You must specify the basis amount range, within which the total exposure will be tracked, using
the exposure category that you have associated, for the customer category type.
For all slabs except the first one, the To Amount of the previous slab must also be equal to the
From Amount of the slab.
The To Amount of a slab must be equal to or greater than the From Amount of the same slab.
Exposure Category
You can specify the exposure category that is to be used to track the total exposure, within the
basis amount range, for the customer category type you have specified.
When the exposure category for a CIF or customer group is derived according to the logic
maintained in the Exposure Category Type Linkage screen, the outstanding overdraft in all
accounts belonging to the group/CIF, as well as the exposure due to loans issued to the group /
CIF is summed, to compute the total exposure.
5-7
5.1.4.3 Specifying Exposure Category for Customer
When you maintain CIF details for customers, in the Customer Information Maintenance screen,
you can specify the exposure category under which exposure due to loans issued to the CIF will
be tracked. The exposure category is derived by the End of Day batch program and displayed, if
the applicable logic has been maintained for the specified customer provisioning group, in the
Exposure Type Category Linkage maintenance. If no logic has been maintained for the group,
you can specify the applicable exposure category.
5.1.5 Maintaining Rules for Provisioning
For each account class for which you have defined account provisioning to be applicable, you can
define the rules according to which the provisioning amount would be computed, when applied to
an account using the class. You can define the provision rules in the Account Class Provisioning
Rule Maintenance screen.
Invoke this screen by typing ‘LDDPRULE’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
The screen is as shown below:
To define rules, you can use the following elements, for the account for which provision is being
made:

Outstanding Balance ACY – This is the book-dated debit balance, in account currency,
in the account for which provision is being made

Outstanding Balance LCY – This is the book-dated debit balance, in local currency, in
the account for which provision is being made

Receivable Interest – This is the interest receivable on the account for which provision is
being made
5-8

Accrued Interest – This is the interest that has been accrued but not liquidated as yet in
the account for which provision is being made; typically, the interest that has accrued
during the current liquidation cycle

Receivable Interest LCY – This is the interest receivable, in local currency, on the
account for which provision is being made

Accrued Interest LCY – This is the interest that has been accrued but not liquidated as
yet, in local currency, on the account for which provision is being made

Account Status – This is the user-defined status for the account for which provision is
being made

Exposure Category– This is the exposure category of the account for which provision is
being made. It is picked up from the account details; if it has not been specified in the
account details, it is picked up from the maintenance for the CIF or customer group to
which the account belongs.

Risk-Free Exposure Amount – This indicates the risk-free amount (collateral) specified
in the details of the account for which provisioning is being made.

Provisioning Percentage – The provisioning percentage is generally picked up from the
account details. If not specified in the account details, it is picked up from the Exposure
Category Provisioning Percentage maintenance, for the exposure category of the
customer of the account and the account status.

Discount Percentage – The discount or loss percentage is used to compute the
recoverable value of the account for which provision is being made. It is picked up from
the account (if specified in the account details) or from the Exposure Category
Provisioning Percentage maintenance, for the exposure category and status of the
account for which provision is being made.

Status Seq – This indicates the sequence number that represents the status, as defined
in the Status Definition. It can be used with arithmetic operators for ease of status rule
definition.
5.1.6 Derivation Rules for Status Change
For accounts, the basis for processing of status changes is governed by an attribute that you set
in the Branch Parameters. You could opt for status processing at a group or CIF level, or at
contract-level.
If processing is done at a customer group or CIF level, it is done in two stages:

The worst status among all accounts and loan contracts belonging to the customer group
or CIF is arrived at

All accounts and contracts belonging to the customer group or CIF are then moved to the
worst status that was arrived at
In the Status Rule Derivation screen, in the Derivation Rule field, you can define the conditions
according to which the status of all accounts using an account class (the aging analysis) could be
tracked. For each account class, you can maintain a derivation rule, which would be used during
status processing to arrive at the status of each account (if status processing is at a contract
level) or the worst status among all accounts and loans belonging to groups or CIF level (if status
processing is at a Group/CIF level)
5-9
To define the derivation rule, you could use a combination of multiple elements, and arithmetic
and logical operators. The following elements may be used:

Frozen

Dormant

Nodebits

Nocredits

Stoppayment

Current Status

Customer Classification
In addition, the following elements will also be available for processing:

OD (overdraft) Days

Inactive Days

Overline Days

TOD (Temporary Overdraft) Days
For details regarding the maintenance of other status control parameters in the Status Rule
Definition screen, refer the chapter Maintaining Mandatory Information in this user manual.
5.2
Maintaining Provisioning Coverage Details
You can maintain the provisioning coverage details for the individual contracts to pick up the
provisioning percentage using ‘Provisioning Coverage Details’ screen. Provisioning is required for
Loan, Leasing, Guarantee, and Over Draft Accounts types of products.
5-10
To invoke this screen, type ‘CSDPROVN’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool
bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
You can specify the following details here:
Provisioning Code
Specify the unique provisioning code for which you want to maintain the coverage details.
Description
You can describe the provisioning code.
Provisioning Coverage Details
Status
Specify the status for which you want to maintain the provisioning coverage from the adjoining
option list.
Sequence Number
System generates the sequence number while saving the record. You cannot amend this
number.
From
Specify the number of days, months or years from which the provision percentage should be
applicable.
5-11
To
Specify the number of days, months or years till which the provision percentage should be
applicable.
Unit
Specify the unit for the provisioning coverage. The adjoining drop-down list has the following
options:

Days

Months

Years
Provisioning Percentage
Specify the provisioning percentage to be applied for the specified period.
5.3
Viewing Provisioning Coverage Details
You can view provisioning coverage details for the individual contracts using ‘Provisioning
Coverage Summary’ screen. To invoke this screen, type ‘CSSPROVN’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
5-12
In the above screen, you can base your queries on any or all of the following parameters and
fetch records:

Authorization Status

Provisioning Code

Record Status

Description
Select any or all of the above parameters for a query and click ‘Search’ button. The records
meeting the selected criteria are displayed.
5.4

Authorization Status

Record Status

Provisioning Code

Description
Maintaining Risk Level Provisioning Rate
You can maintain the alpha and the beta provisioning rates for each risk level using ‘Risk
Provisioning Rate Maintenance’ screen. This maintenance will be done at the head-office and will
apply to all the branches. To invoke this screen, type ‘CSDAPBTR’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
You can specify the following details here:
Risk Level
Specify the risk level from the adjoining drop-down list. You can select any one of the following:
5-13

Negligible risk

Low risk

Medium-low risk

Medium risk

Medium-high risk

High risk
Alpha Rate
Specify the alpha rate percentage for the selected risk.
Beta Rate
Specify the beta rate percentage for the selected risk.
Transaction Code
Specify the transaction code that will be used for the accounting entries from the adjoining option
list.
Provision Expense GL
Specify the GL for accounting entries at risk level. The adjoining option list displays all the GL
belong to expense category. Select the appropriate one.
GL Description
System displays the description for the provision expense GL.
Provision Liability GL
Specify the GL for accounting entries at risk level. The adjoining option list displays all the GL
belong to liability category. Select the appropriate one.
GL Description
System displays the description for the provision liability GL.
Note the following:
Provisioning will be based on the following parameters:

If the status of contract is doubtful, then the system calculates the provision amount
separately for each contract.

If the status of the contract is not doubtful, then Grouping needs to be done at Risk Level
and Country Group Level separately at the bank level for all the customers.
5-14

5.5
If the Risk Level is changed, then during next provisioning process, provisioning amount
will be recalculated and accounting will be updated accordingly.
Viewing Risk Level Provisioning Rate
You can view the alpha and the beta provisioning rates for each risk level using ‘Risk Provisioning
Rate Summary’ screen. To invoke this screen, type ‘CSSAPBTR’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
In the above screen, you can base your queries on any or all of the following parameters and
fetch records:

Authorization Status

Record Status

Risk Level
Select any or all of the above parameters for a query and click ‘Search’ button. The records
meeting the selected criteria are displayed.

Authorization Status

Record Status

Risk Level
5-15
5.6
Maintaining Country Group Provisioning Rates
You can maintain the country group provisioning rates for country groups using ‘Country Group
Provisioning Rates Maintenance’ screen. This maintenance will be done at the head-office and
will apply to all the branches. To invoke this screen, type ‘CSDCGRPR’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
You can specify the following details here:
Country Group Code
Specify the country group code. The adjoining option list displays the list of country group codes
maintained in the system. Select the appropriate one.
Group Code Description
System displays the group code description for the selected country group code.
Group Rate
Specify the group rate percentage for each country.
Transaction Code
Specify the transaction code that will be used for the accounting entries from the adjoining option
list.
Provision Expense GL
Specify the GL for accounting entries at country group level. The adjoining option list displays all
the GLs belonging to provision category. Select the appropriate one.
5-16
GL Description
System displays the description for the provision expense GL.
Provision Liability GL
Specify the GL for accounting entries at country group level. The adjoining option list displays all
the GLs belonging to liability category. Select the appropriate one.
GL Description
System displays the description for the provision liability GL.
5.7
Viewing Country Group Provisioning Rates
You can view the country group provisioning rates for country groups using ‘Country Group
Provisioning Rates Maintenance’ screen. To invoke this screen, type ‘CSSCGRPR’ in the field at
the top right corner of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
In the above screen, you can base your queries on any or all of the following parameters and
fetch records:

Authorization Status

Country Group Code

Provision Expense GL
5-17

Transaction Code

Record Status

Group Rate

Provision Liability GL
Select any or all of the above parameters for a query and click ‘Search’ button. The records
meeting the selected criteria are displayed.
5.8

Authorization Status

Record Status

Country Group Code

Group Rate

Provision Expense GL

Provision Liability GL

Transaction Code
Viewing Manual Provisioning
You can view manual provisioning amount computed for risk and country group using ‘Manual
Provisioning’ screen. To invoke this screen, type ‘CSDMPROV’ in the field at the top right corner
of the Application tool bar and click the adjoining arrow button.
5-18
Processed as on
Specify the date on which the group provision was computed from the adjoining calendar.
Processed By
System displays the value to indicate whether the group provisioning has been running during
EOD or manually through intraday batch. It can be one of the following:

Automatic

Manual
Bank Code
System displays the bank code here.
Order of Process
You can view the order of processing here if the group provisioning has run multiple times a day.
You can click on the ‘Process Accounting’ button to manually initiate the accounting.
System will display the accounting entries for the following:

Risk Level Alpha

Risk Level Beta

Country Group Provision
You can select the specific records for ‘Risk Level Alpha’; ‘Risk Level Beta’; and ‘Country
Group Level’ for accounting.
5-19
5.8.1 Viewing Contract Details
You can view contract details using ‘Contract Details’ screen. Click on the ‘Contract Details’
button to invoke this screen.
5.9
Provisioning Computation batches
CSBGRPRV
This batch is configured and run at the head office level.
This computes the provision amount at risk level and country group level for all contracts across
branches for group provisioning. System will not pass accounting during batch. It only logs
provision amount.
System selects the contracts with:

The status ‘Active’

The check box Group Provisioning Required’ is checked

The Coverage maintenance doesn’t exist.
Risk Provisioning
Contracts will be grouped based on the risk level. Total debt amount will be computed based on
the risk components maintained at product level and the outstanding amounts for these
components maintained with the same risk level.
5-20
Contracts picked for the risk provisioning in every batch will be stored in data store along with the
total debt for each contract.
Country Group Level
Contracts will be grouped based on the country group level. Total debt amount will be computed
based on country group components maintained at the product level; outstanding amounts for
these components maintained for the same country group; provisioning rate maintained at the
country group level.
Contracts picked for the country group provisioning in every batch will be stored in data store
along with the total debt for each contract.
CSBPROVN
EOD Batch will be triggered post EOTI batch to compute provisioning for Leasing, Loans,
Guarantee, and Overdraft accounts.
5.9.1 Provision Processing for Accounts
Provision processing for customer accounts is only done if indicated in the account details.
Provision processing depends upon the status processing for accounts.
The Provisioning Batch
For accounts for which provisioning has been indicated, a batch process is run subsequent to the
following processes, to perform provisioning:

Status processing for accounts

Interest and Charges (IC) batch process

The Automatic Daily Contract Update process in the Loans module
To trigger the provisioning batch, you can use the Provisioning Batch screen. When the batch is
triggered, the provisioning events SPRO (provision) and SPWB (write back) are executed.
5.9.1.1 Specifying Frequency at which Provisioning Batch is Executed
To recall, provision processing depends upon status processing for accounts and contracts. The
provisioning batch executes after the status processing batch, as explained in the previous
section. If status processing is indicated to be processed at group/CIF level, you can indicate the
frequency at which the provisioning batch is to be executed for your branch.
You can specify the provisioning frequency in the Branch Parameters Preferences screen. The
frequency options available are daily and monthly.
5-21
To view the Branch Parameters Preferences screen, refer the Core Services user manual.
The Provisioning Process
If status processing for your branch is done at customer group/CIF level, (as specified in the
Branch Parameters), the provisioning process executes according to the frequency defined in the
Branch Parameters. The process executes as described below:
1. The exposure categories for the customer group or CIF are first derived, either from the
specification for the same in the contract and account details, or depending upon the total
exposure of the group or CIF, according to the logic maintained for deriving the exposure
category, in the Exposure Type – Category Linkage maintenance
When the exposure category for a CIF or customer group is derived according to the
logic maintained in the Exposure Category Type Linkage screen, the outstanding overdraft in
all accounts belonging to the group/CIF, as well as the exposure due to loans issued to the
group/CIF is summed, to compute the total exposure
2. The provisioning percentage applicable is then derived, either from the contract and account
details, or using the exposure category of the CIF and the status of all accounts and contracts
involving the CIF, according to the linkage maintained in the Exposure Category Provisioning
Percentage maintenance
3. Having obtained the provisioning percentage applicable, the system then computes the
provision amount, based on the rule defined in the Loans Provisioning Rule maintenance (for
loans) and the Account Provisioning Rule Maintenance (for accounts).
4. The computed provision amount would then be stored for the accounts and contracts, and
appropriate accounting entries passed. The computed provision amount is stored and
displayed in the Amount Tab in the Customer Account Maintenance. The current status and
exposure category of the account is also stored along with the balances.
In case of contracts, the provision amount is not re-computed when a contract amendment,
value-dated amendment, or automatic or manual payment is done, but only as part of the
provisioning batch. On maturity of the contract, the provision amount is reversed. Similarly in the
case of accounts, the provision amount is written back when the account is closed.
5.9.1.2 Computation of Provision Amount
When status processing is done at a group or CIF level,

The worst status among all contracts and accounts under a specific customer group or
CIF is arrived at

All accounts and contracts with automatic status processing involving the customer group
or CIF are then moved to the worst status that was arrived at.

The total exposure of customers in a group or CIF is considered as the sum of all
outstanding overdrafts in respect of accounts belonging to the group/ CIF, as well as the
loans issued to the group or CIF. This total exposure is considered for deriving the
provision percentage, and computation of the provision amount.
5-22

The computed provision amount is stored and displayed in the Amount Tab in the
Customer Account Maintenance. The current status and exposure category of the
account is also stored along with the balances.
The provision amount is computed for each account using the provision rule defined for the
account class that the account uses. Typically, the computation could be done according to the
following guidelines:
Status of the Accounts
For instance, let us suppose the statuses for accounts belonging to a CIF are derived according
to the following guidelines:
Delay Period
Debtor
Financial
Standing
Up to 30
days
Between 31
and 60 days
Between 61
and 90 days
Between
91 and
180
days
Beyond
180
days
Good
Regular
Watch
Substandard
Doubtful
Loss
Unstable
Watch
Substandard
Doubtful
Loss
Loss
Not Good
Substandard
Doubtful
Loss
Loss
Loss
Deteriorate
Doubtful
Loss
Loss
Loss
Loss
Bad
Loss
Loss
Loss
Loss
Loss
Provision for General Credit Risk
General Credit Risk includes all contracts and accounts in ‘Regular’ status. The provision amount
computation could be done as follows, according to the following categories:
Exposure to Corporate Customers
The expression used for this category could be:
PA  OD  RFC   PP , where,
PA = Provisioning Amount,
OD = Outstanding Overdraft Amount = Principal + Overdue Interest,
RFC = Risk-free Collateral,
PP = Provisioning Percentage
The provisioning percentage could be computed as shown:
5-23
Loan Type
Categorization
Provision
Corporate Small – (CS)
Exposure <= BGN 50,000
1.5%
Corporate Intermediate –
(CI)
Exposure > BGN 50,000 and <= BGN
500,000
2.0%
Corporate Large – (CL)
Exposure > BGN 500,000 and < L-Sig
3.0%
Corporate Big – (CB)
Exposure >= L-Sig
0.0%
Here, L-Sig could correspond to one percent of bank’s capital base rounded to nearest lower
amount divisible by 50,000. Typically, the bank sets this figure.
In arriving at the total exposure figure (as shown in the table above), the outstanding
overdraft in the account as well as the outstanding amounts on all loans issued to the group/CIF
that the account belongs to, are summed.
Example
Customer
Exposure
Amount (BGN)
Type
Account 1
Loan 1
20,000
CI
Loan 2
15,000
CI
Account Overdraft
12,000
CI
Loan 3
5,000
CI
Loan 4
5,000
CI
Account 1 Overdraft
26,000
CI
Account 2 Overdraft
15,000
CI
Sum of total exposure amounts
98,000
Account 2
Exposure to Retail Customers
The expression used for this category could be:
PA  OD  RFC   PP , where
PA = Provisioning Amount
OD = Outstanding Overdraft Amount = Principal + Overdue Interest
RFC = Risk-free Collateral
5-24
PP = Provisioning Percentage
5-25
The provisioning percentage could be computed as shown:
Loan Type
Categorization
Percentage
Retail OD – (RO)
Retail Overdrafts
1.5%
Retail Mortgages –
(RM)
Retail Loans that has mortgages
as collateral
2.0%
Retail Consumer
(RC)
Other than the above
1.5%
Provisioning for Impairment Losses
Impairment losses include loans that are not in the ‘Regular’ status. The provision amount
computation could be done as follows, according to the following categories:
All Corporate customers regardless of exposure and Retail customers with exposure exceeding
BGN 5000
The expression used for this category could be:
PA  BVE  RV  RFC   PP
Where
PA = Provisioning Amount
BVE = Balance Value of Risk Exposure = Outstanding Overdraft amount (which is, Principal +
Balance Overdue Interest)
RFC = Risk-free Collateral
RV = Recoverable Value
PP = Provisioning Percentage
The recoverable value could be computed by applying the discount percentage to the balance
expected cash flow, as shown:
Status
Minimum Limit
Accepted discount
Watch
10%
25%
Substandard
30%
50%
5-26
Doubtful
50%
75%
Loss
100%
100%
The resultant amount could be discounted using the overdraft interest rate. For loans in status
‘LOSS’, the recoverable value is zero.
An example for the provision amount calculation for accounts in impairment loss
For an account in respect of which the balance value of exposure is BGN 700 and the balance overdue
interest is BGN 100, the outstanding overdraft amount = 700 + 100 = BGN 800.
If the account is in ‘WATCH’ status, the applicable discount (or loss) percentage for the account is 25 %
Therefore, the recoverable value of the exposure = 800 – (800 * 25%) = BGN 600
If the risk free collateral is BGN 100, the provision amount = 800 – 600 – 100 = 100
Retail Customers with Exposure Less than BGN 5000
The expression used for this category could be:
PA  OD  RFC   PP , where
PA = Provisioning Amount
OD = Outstanding Overdraft Amount = Principal + Overdue Interest
RFC = Risk-free Collateral
PP = Provisioning Percentage
The provisioning percentage could be computed as shown:
Status
Provisioning Percentage
Watch
10%
Substandard
30%
Doubtful
50%
Loss
100%
The provisioning would be done for individual accounts as shown above.
5-27
5.9.1.3 Specifying Rebooking Provision Entries
In the Status Details function, you can indicate whether provisioning entries for an account must
be rebooked when provisioning is done after an automatic status change for the account.
Rebooking essentially means that fresh provisioning is done, after reversing the previous
provisioning amount.
The provisioning batch process, when executed, not only computes the provisioning amount; it
also records the current status of the account and checks whether the current status is different
from the status that was prevalent when the process was previously executed. If so, the old
provisioning amount is written back into the write back GL of the old status (if the Rebook
Provision option has been set in the Status Details), and the entries for the new provisioning
amount are booked into the provisioning GLs maintained for the current status in the Status
Details.
If the Rebook Provision has not been set, there is no reversal of the old provisioning amount, and
the differential provisioning entries are be passed, as usual, into the GLs maintained for the
current status. When there is a status change between two provisioning cycles, the Rebook
Provision option is set for the status with the higher sequence number. For instance, while
moving from status NORM (Normal) to PDO1 (Past Due Obligation), the Rebook Provision option
is set for the status PDO1 and while moving from PDO1 to NORM, the Rebook Provision option is
set for the status PDO1 again.
If manual provisioning has been done, the entries for the differential amount are passed or
written back into the GLs associated with the NORM (normal) status.
5.9.1.4 Maintaining Accounting Entries for Provisioning
The computed provision amount is stored and displayed in the Amount Tab in the Customer
Account Maintenance. The current status and exposure category of the account is also stored
along with the balances.
For account provisioning, accounting entries are passed for the following:

Changes in provisioning amount without status change

Reversal of provisioning amount as a result of status change
Accounting Entries for Changes in Provision Amount without Change in Status
The entries passed for new provisions or increase of provision amount:
Dr:
Expense GL
Cr:
Provisioning GL
Entries for decrease in provision amount:
Dr:
Provisioning GL
5-28
Cr:
Reintegration GL
Accounting entries for change in status with/without changes in provision Amount and
with the Rebook Provision option applicable
In this case, the existing entries are reversed into a reintegration GL and new provisioning entries
are booked, provided the ‘Rebook Provision on Status Change’ option has been set for the new
status of the account. In this case, the following entries would be passed
For reversal of provision amount
Dr:
Provisioning GL
Cr:
Reintegration GL
For booking of new provision amount
Dr:
Expense GL
Cr:
Provisioning GL
5-29
6.
6.1
Customer Information Query
Introduction
You can access the following information through the Customer Information Query screen:
6.2

Customer Limits, specifically relating to Overdraft Limits on Current Accounts and
Foreign Exchange Exposure Limits

Details relating to a Customer Account

Facility to query for Account statement

Facility to view future settlement balance/contracts

Facility to view Asset and Liability Balances of the customer

Facility to view summary of Collaterals and Account Details
Invoking Customer Position Screen
Invoke the ‘Customer Information Query’ screen, by typing ‘ACDSCPQR’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
6-1
The screen displays all the accounts linked to the selected customer for the specified date range,
and grouped by Branch, Customer Account, and Currency.
If you check the ‘Linked Customer’ check box and provide the Customer Number and click
‘Query’ button, all linked customers of the customer number entered will be displayed.
To query on any linked customer displayed, select the customer and click ‘Fetch’ button. A query
operation is performed on the selected customer and the details are displayed. The displayed
values are based on the query parameters provided.
6.2.1 Viewing Account Details
You can view details of all the accounts linked to the selected customer through the Customer
Position screen. Click the Accounts tab. The screen appears as shown below:
You can run the query based on following parameters:
Customer
Select the customer number from the adjoining option list. The available options are:

Customer Number

Document ID Number
6-2

Customer Name
Address
Specify the customer address.
Linked Customer
Check Linked Customer and provide Customer Number then click Query button to view all the
Account Numbers of the customer and its linked customers.
Branch
You can indicate whether only customer accounts in the current branch should be displayed or
customer accounts across branches should be displayed. Check this box to view customer
accounts pertaining to the current branch.
Indicating whether to include Relationship
While querying for the customer position, you can choose to include all the accounts, loans or
deposits where the customer is not the primary holder. To indicate this, choose the check box
Include Relationship. The summary screen displays the customer number or primary holder of the
account, the customer’s name, and the relationship that the customer has with the account.
If you leave this box unchecked, system will display the account details of primary account holder
only.
If you are allowed to query customer information, then system displays the following details
pertaining to the fetched records:

Customer

Description

Currency

Current Balance

Related Customer

Relationship

Debit Credit Indicator

Joint Holder Relationship
6.2.2 Viewing Loans Details
You can view details of all loan contracts for the selected customer through the Customer
Position screen. Click the Loans tab. The loan amount that appears is the consolidated amount
grouped by Branch, Product, and Currency.
6-3
The screen appears as shown below:
Double clicking a record displays the Loan Contracts Summary screen comprising a summary of
transactions contributing to the balance displayed in the Customer Position screen. The balance
displayed is the outstanding principal amount for the Loan product. This screen also displays MM
contracts, that is, MM borrowings are displayed under the Deposits tab and MM Placements are
displayed under Loans. Double clicking a record in the Loans Contract Summary screen displays
the corresponding Loan Contract screen comprising transaction details.
6-4
The summary screen will not be shown for contracts that do not belong to the current branch
For more details on the LD Contract Online screen, please refer the Loans User Manual
6.2.3 Viewing Deposit Details
You can view details of all Deposit contracts for the selected customer through the Customer
Position screen. Click the Deposits tab. The deposit amount that appears is the consolidated
amount grouped by Branch, Product and Currency.
6-5
The screen appears as shown below:
Double clicking a record displays the Deposits Contracts Summary screen comprising a summary
of transactions contributing to the balance displayed in the Customer Position screen (MM
borrowings + Deposits). The Balance is the principal balance for the selected Deposit product.
Double clicking a record in the Loans and Deposits Contract Summary screen displays the
corresponding Deposit Contract screen comprising transaction details.
6-6
The summary screen will not be displayed if the deposit does not belong to the current
branch
For more details on the Contract Online screen, please refer the user manual for Deposits.
6.2.4 Viewing FX Details
You can view details of all FX contracts for the selected customer through the Customer Position
screen. The entries are the consolidated amounts for contracts grouped by product, branch and
currency. Double clicking a record displays the summary screen for that record and double
clicking further, displays the contract details screen for that record. Click the FX tab.
6-7
The screen appears as shown below:
Here, the FX bought amount is displayed as Debit Balance and the FX sold amount is displayed
as Credit Account.
Double clicking a record in the Customer Position screen displays the corresponding FX Contract
Summary screen. Double clicking a record in the FX Contract Summary screen displays the
corresponding FX Contract Detail screen comprising the transaction details.
6.2.5 Viewing FT Details
You can view details of all FT contracts for the selected customer through the Customer Position
screen. Click the FT tab.
6-8
The screen appears as shown below:
The Balance amount displayed here is the incoming cash flow amount or credit balance for the
FT product.
Double clicking a record in the Customer Position screen displays the corresponding FT Contract
Summary screen. Double clicking a record in the FT Contract Summary screen displays the
corresponding FT Contract Detail screen comprising the transaction details.
6.2.6 Viewing Collaterals Details
You can view the collateral details for the selected customer through the Customer Position
screen. Click the ‘Collateral’ button. The Collateral Summary View screen appears for all
collaterals linked to the customer liability.
6-9
Double clicking a record in the Collaterals Summary screen displays the details of the selected
collateral.
6.2.7 Viewing Assets/Liabilities Details
You can view the total asset and total liability for the selected customer through the Customer
Position screen. Click the ‘Asset/Liab’ button. The Assets/Liabilities Summary screen appears. All
Assets and Liabilities transactions are displayed in Asset and Liabilities transaction blocks along
with the local currency equivalent for each transaction. The total for Assets and the total for
Liabilities are also displayed at the end of each block.
Asset = Sum of Current balance of All the account having –ve balance + Sum of all the Loans
outstanding balance Linked to a given customer + Sum of all MM placements of the customers
Liability = Sum of Current balance of all the account having +ve balance + Sum of all the
Deposits Linked to a given customer + Sum of all MM borrowings of the customer.
6-10
Invoke the ‘Customer Asset & Liability Query screen, by typing ‘ACDSQASL’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Customer Liability
The following customer liability details are displayed based on the query parameters provided:

Authorized Status

Contract Status

Branch

Reference Number

Customer

Currency

Debit/Credit

Amount

Local Currency Amount

Value Date
The following account status details are displayed based on the query parameters provided:

Status Dormant
6-11

No Debit

No Credit

Frozen
6.2.8 Viewing Limits Details
Check Linked Customer and provide Customer Number and click Query button to view all linked
customers in Linked Customer Details. To query on any linked customer displayed, select the
customer and click ‘Fetch’ button. A query operation is performed on the selected customer and
the details are displayed. The displayed values are based on the query parameters provided.
You can view details of limits maintained for the selected customer through the Customer
Position screen. Click the ‘Limits’ button. The Liability Summary screen appears. Double clicking
on a record displays the Limits Line Summary screen which provides a summary view of all the
lines linked to the liability of the customer. Double clicking on a record in the Limits Line Summary
screen, displays the utilization summary screen.
6.2.9 Viewing MIS Details
You can view MIS information about the selected customer through the Customer Position
screen. Click MIS tab.
For more details on the MIS screen, refer the MIS User Manual
6-12
6.2.10 Viewing Projections
You can view future settlement balances and outstanding FX and FT contracts for the selected
customer account through the Customer Position screen. Click ‘Projection’ button.
Invoke the ‘Customer Projections Query’ screen, by typing ‘ACDSQPRO’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
To view the settlement balance for the selected customer for a particular future date, enter a date
in the date field and click the ‘Q’ button. The system displays details of all the unsettled
transactions, which have occurred until the date indicated in the “Date” field. ‘’Total’’ indicates the
sum total of all unsettled transactions in local currency for the selected customer number.
Check Linked Customer and provide Customer Number and click Query button to view all linked
customers in Linked Customer Details. To query on any linked customer displayed, select the
customer and click ‘Fetch’ button. A query operation is performed on the selected customer and
the details are displayed. The displayed values are based on the query parameters provided.
Double clicking a record in this screen invokes the contract summery screen for the selected
contract. The current balance of the selected customer is displayed at the bottom of this screen.
The current balance denotes the sum total of balances in all the accounts of the selected
customer.
6-13
6.2.11 Viewing Accounting Entries
You can view all the accounting entries passed for a selected Customer Account in the
Accounting Entry Retrieval screen. To invoke this screen, select a customer account and a date
range in the Customer Position screen and then click ‘Accounting’ button.
The Accounting Entry Retrieval screen is displayed with all the accounting entries passed for the
selected customer account and date range:
Double clicking on an accounting entry in this screen displays the corresponding contract input
screen.
Click ‘Query’ button if you wish to query for any particular accounting entry
6.2.12 Overdrawn Accounts Query
Invoke the ‘Overdrawn Accounts Query’ screen, by typing ‘ACDCODQS’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
6-14
The screen is as shown below:
You can view the following information in this screen:

Customer Number

Account Branch

Account Number

Account Currency

Facility Identifier

Liability Number

Payable Balance
Linked Customer
Check Linked Customer and provide Customer Number and click Query button to view all the
Overdrawn Account Numbers of the customer and its linked customers.
Linked Account
Check Linked Account and provide Account Number and click Query to view all Overdrawn
Account Numbers of the customer of the account. The displayed values are based on the query
fields provided.
6-15
6.2.13 Uncollected Funds Query
Invoke the ‘Uncollected Funds Query’ screen, by typing ‘ACDFUNCO’ in the field at the top right
corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
You can view the following information in this screen

Available Date

Transfer Reference Number

Bank Code

Amount

Amount Number
Linked Account
Check Linked Account and provide Account Number and click Query to view all Uncollected Fund
Account Numbers of the customer and its linked customers. When Linked Account is not checked
the existing query operation takes place. The displayed values are based on the query fields
provided.
6.2.14 Customer Account Balance Query
You can use the Balance Enquiry screen to view the account balance details of any particular
account of the selected customer.
6-16
Invoke the ‘Customer Account Balance Query’ screen, by typing ‘ACDCBIRD’ in the field at the
top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Linked Customer
Check Linked Customer and provide Customer Number then click Query button to view all the
Account Numbers of the customer and its linked customers.
Linked Account
Check Linked Account and provide Account Number then click Query to view all account
numbers of the customer of the account. The displayed values are based on the query fields
provided.
The following account balance details are displayed based on the query parameters provided:

Account Number

Currency

Current Balance

Available Balance

Utilized Line Amount

Total Available Balance

Uncollected Funds

Amount Blocked
6-17

Tod Limit

Sublimit

Uncollected Funds Limit

Accrued Interest Debit

Accrued Interest Credit

The following account status details are displayed based on the query parameters provided:

Status Dormant

No Debit

No Credit

Frozen
The account status details can also be viewed by placing the cursor in the ‘Account Number’ field
and pressing the hot key F11.
6-18
7.
7.1
360 Degree Customer View
Introduction
Oracle FLEXCUBE allows you to view and analyze personal and business details of the
customers. You can query customer limits, account statements, view settlement balances
contracts, view assets and liability balances of the customer. You can also view summary of
collateral and account details. The 360 degree customer view facilitates easy and total view of the
customer details and reduces customer service complexities.
7.2
Invoking 360Degree Customer View Entry Screen
Invoke the ‘360Degree Customer View Entry Point’ screen, by typing ‘STSCUSVW’ in the field at
the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking the adjoining arrow button.
Here you can query on the basis of any one of the following details:

Customer No

Short Name

Unique identifier Name

National ID

External Reference
7-1

Full Name

Unique Identifier value
On entering any one of the following details and clicking ‘Search’, the system displays the
following details:

Customer Number

External Reference

Short Name

Full name

Unique Identifier Name

Unique Identifier Value

Passport Number

Telephone

Mobile Number
When you double click on the customer record, the system will launch either Retail view
screen or corporate view screen depending on the type of customer.
7.3
Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer Details
You can invoke ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen if the customer is Retail by double
clicking on the customer record in the ‘360Degree Customer View Entry Point’ screen or by typing
‘STDRETVW’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking on the
adjoining arrow button.
7-2
The system displays the following details:

Customer Number

Short Name

Reporting Currency

Branch

Full Name
Click the ‘Reports’ button to view the ‘360 Degree Customer Report’ screen.
The details that can be viewed in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen is classified into
12 broad heads.
Summary
You can view the address, status. Balance sheet asset and
liabilities and off balance sheet asset and liabilities under the
summary tab.
Profile
You can view the details of the customer’s profile.
Deposits
You can view the details of the customer deposits.
Loans
You can view the details of the customer’s loan.
Events
You can view the details of the upcoming events.
Schemes
Alerts
You can to view the details of the relationship schemes.
You can view the alerts for overdue loans, matured deposits
but not renewed or liquidated, Locker Charges Overdue
Details, Cheques Returned, Amount Block Details and Stop
7-3
Payment Details.
Limits
Payments
Is-Deposits
IsFinancing
External
Products
7.3.1
You can view the limits and collaterals of the customer.
You can view the FT and PC contracts of the customer which
is not liquidated.
You can view details about active CASA account and Term
Deposit.
You can view details about Islamic Account and Islamic Term
Deposit..
You can view external details about products like credit
cards, insurance, and mutual fund.
Viewing Summary Details
You can view the address, status. Balance sheet asset and liabilities and off balance sheet asset
and liabilities under the summary tab. The following details are displayed here:
Address For Correspondence
Here you can view the following details:

Name

Address

Telephone

Fax

E-mail
Status
Here you can view the following details:

Frozen

Deceased

Whereabouts Unknown

KYC Status

CIF Status

Since

Credit Rating
7-4

Customer Category

Charge Group

Tax Group
Balance Sheet Asset and Liabilities
Here you can view the following details:

Asset

Ccy

Value

Liability

Ccy

Value
Off Balance Sheet Asset and Liabilities
Here you can view the following details:

Asset

Ccy

Value

Liability

Ccy

Value
7.3.2 Viewing Profile Details
7-5
Click ‘Profile’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
customer’s profile.
Here you can view the following details:





Name

First

Middle

Last
Sex

Male

Female
Resident Status

Resident

Non Resident

Joint Customer
Domicile address

Line 1 to 3

Country

Mobile Number
Unique Identifier

Name

Value
7-6




Passport Details

Passport Number

Issue Date

Expiry date
Permanent Address

Line 1 to 3

Country
Geographic

Country

Nationality

Language

National Id
Legal Guardian

Date of Birth

Guardian

Submit age Proof
7.3.2.1 Viewing Signature Image and Photograph of the customer
Click on the ‘Image’ button to invoke ‘Customer Signatory Details’ screen. Here you can view the
signature image and photograph of the customer.
Here you can view the following details:

Signature Id
7-7

Signature Title

Signature

Image
7.3.2.2 Viewing Related Customer Details
Click on the ‘Linked Customers’ button to invoke ‘Linked Entities’ screen. Here you can view other
related customer details.
Here you can view the following details:

Customer

Description

Relations
7.3.2.3 Viewing Locker Details
Click on the ‘Locker Details’ button to invoke ‘Safe Deposit Locker Details’ screen. Here you can
view the locker details of the customer.
7-8
The screen is as shown below:
Here, you can view the following details:

Contract Reference

SD Vault Code

SD Box Code

Box Type

Box Dimension

Box Description

Contract Currency

Deposit Amount

Tenor

Issue Date

Closure date

Expiry Date
7.3.2.4 Viewing Professional Details of the Customer
Click on the ‘Professional’ button to invoke ‘Customer Professional Details’ screen. Here you can
view the professional details of the customer.
7-9
The screen is as shown below:
7.3.2.5 Viewing Domestic Details of the Customer
Click on the ‘Domestic’ button to invoke ‘Customer Domestic Details’ screen. Here you can view
the domestic details of the customer.
Here you can view the following details:

Marital status

Spouse Employment Status

Accommodation

Spouse Name
7-10

Dependents

Children

Others
7.3.2.6 Viewing Customer information
Click on the ‘Joint’ button to invoke ‘Customer Information Maintenance’ screen. Here you can
view information about the customer.
Here you can view the following details:

Customer No

Sex

Male

Female

Prefix

First name

Last Name

Middle

Address line 1 to 3

Passport Details

Passport Number

Issue Date
7-11

Expiry Date

Date of Birth

Resident status


Resident

Non Resident
Deceased

Deceased

Non Deceased

Telephone

E-mail

SSN
7.3.2.7 Viewing Customer Entities
Click on the ‘Linked Entity’ button to invoke ‘Linked Entity’ screen. Here you can view details
about customers who are linked to this customer, accounts for which this customer is linked, and
loans which are guaranteed by this customer.
7-12
CASA Details of Linked Customers
Here you can view the following details:

Branch Code

Account No

Account Description

Current Balance

Available Balance

Blocked

Uncollected

Debit Interest Accrued Amount

Credit Interest Accrued Amount

Limit Currency

Temp. OD limit

Temp. OD Start

Temp. OD End

Account Status

Since

Related Customer

Account Class
Retail Deposits of linked Customers
Here you can view the following details:

Branch Code

Account No

Account Description

term Deposit amount

Maturity Date

Interest Start Date

tenor in Days

Interest Rate

Last Interest Effective Date

Interest Accrued
7-13

Account Status

Since

account Class

Recurring Deposit
Corporate Deposits of Linked Customers
Here you can view the following details:

Branch

Contract Reference

Product Description

Currency

Booking Date

Value Date

maturity date

Interest Rate

Contract Status

Product

No of Times Rollover

Related Customer
Loan Details of linked Customers
Here you can view the following details:

Branch Code

Account Number

Product description

currency

Amount financed

Amount Disbursed

outstanding Amount

Booking Dated

Value Date

Maturity Date
7-14
7.3.2.8 Viewing KYC Details
Click on the ‘KYC Details’ button to invoke ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen. Here you can view KYC
details of the customer.
Refer Core Entities for more information about the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen.
7.3.2.9 Viewing User Defined Fields
Click on the ‘Fields’ button to invoke ‘User Defined Fields’ screen. Here you can view the UDF
details of the customer.
The screen is as shown below:
7-15
7.3.2.10
Viewing MIS Details
Click on the ‘MIS’ button to invoke ‘MIS’ screen. Here you can view the MIS details of the
customer.
7.3.3 Viewing Deposit Details
Click ‘Deposits’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
customer deposits.
7-16
The screen is as shown below:
CASA Deposits
Here, you can view the following details for an active CASA account:

Branch code

Account

Description

Account Class

Related Customer

Account Status

Status Since

Currency

Current Balance

Available Balance

Uncollected amount

Blocked amount

Debit Interest Accrued Amount

Credit Interest Accrued Amount

Limit Currency
7-17

TOD Limit

TOD Limit Start Date

TOD Limit End Date

Account Type(Single or Joint)

Relationship
Closed accounts will not be displayed.
Retail Deposit Details
You can view the following details about the retail deposit:

Account Number

Branch Code

Description

Account Class

Related Customer

Status

Since

Currency

Term Deposit Amount

Maturity date

Interest Start Date

Account type(Joint or single)

Tenor – Tenor will be displayed in terms of days.

Interest rate – Interest Rate of a deposit. System will pick up the current interest rate of a
deposit during query.

Latest Interest Effective Date – System will pick up latest interest effective date of a
deposit during query.

Interest Accrued – Interest accrued till date for an account. This will be derived by the
system during query.

Recurring Deposit- This check box will be checked if it is Recurring Deposit

Relationship
Corporate Deposit Details
You can view the following Corporate Deposit details:
7-18

Contract Reference Number

Customer No

Product

Product Description

Currency

Amount

Maturity Date

Booking Date

Value Date

Contract Status

No of times Rollover – the system displays the number of times roll over has been done
for deposit. This is arrived during query.

Interest Rate – the system displays the current interest rate of a deposit. This is arrived
during query.
7.3.3.1 Viewing Account Signatory
Click ‘Account Signatory’ button to view the ‘Signatory Details’ screen. In this screen, you can
view the signatory details of the selected account.
Refer the section ‘Specifying Account Signatory Details’ under the ‘Current and Savings Account’
module for more information.
7-19
7.3.3.2 Viewing Standing Instruction
Click ‘Standing Instruction’ button to view the ‘Standing Instruction Details’ screen. In this screen
you can view the standing instructions which have debit account as account selected from
multiple block.
Here you can view the following details:

Instruction Number

SI Type

First Execution date

Next Execution Date

SI Expiry Date

Processing Time

Credit Account

Credit Account Branch

SI Amount Currency

SI Amount

Product Code
7-20
7.3.3.3 Viewing Periodic Instructions
Click ‘Periodic Instructions’ button to view the ‘Periodic Instructions’ screen. In this screen, you
can view the period instructions which have debit account as account selected from multiple block
Here you can view the following details:

Instruction Reference Number

Product Code

Product Category

Customer account Branch

Counter Party Account Number

Counter Party Name

Transaction Currency

Transaction Amount

Next Generation date

Execution days

Execution Months

Execution Years

End date
7-21
7.3.3.4 Viewing Transactions
Click ‘Transactions’ button to view the ‘Customer Account Transaction Query’ screen. In this
screen, you can query the transactions of an account during a given period.
Refer the section ‘Querying Accounting Entries’ under ‘Core Services’ module for more
information.
7.3.3.5 Viewing Cheques
Click ‘Cheques’ button to view the ‘Cheque Details’ screen. In this screen, you can view the
details of the cheques which are issued for a given period.
7-22
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can view the following details:

Cheque Book Number

Cheque Number

Status

Presentation Date
7.3.3.6 Viewing Statement Generation
Click ‘Statement Generation’ button to view the ‘Account Statement Report’ screen. In this
screen, you can generate adhoc statement for an account.
7-23
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section ‘Account Statement Report’ under ‘Current and Savings Account’ module for
more information.
7.3.3.7 Viewing Cards Details
Click ‘Cards’ button to view the ‘Debit Card Details’ screen. In this screen, you can view details
about active debit cards which are issued during given period for an account.
7-24
Here, you can view the following details:

Branch Code

Card Number

Primary card

Name On Card

Card Expiry Date

Dispatch Status

Pin Mailed Status

Card Status

ATM Limit Unit

ATM Count Unit

ATM Amount Limit

POS Limit unit

POS Count Limit

POS Amount Limit
7.3.3.8 Viewing Other Details
Click ‘Others’ button to view the ‘Other Details Of Account’ screen. In this screen, you can view
additional details about interest, limit, statement, account and nominees.
Here, you can view the following details:

Credit Interest Accrued Amount – the system displays the credit interest accrued. This
value is arrived during query.
7-25

Debit Interest Accrued Amount – the system displays the debit interest accrued till date
for an account. This value is arrived during query.

TOD Limit Start Date.

TOD Limit End Date.

Limit Currency

TOD Limit

Lind Id

Last Statement Date

Last Statement Balance

Last Statement Number

No Debit

No Credit

Stop Payment

Dormant

Frozen.

Nominees
7.3.3.9 Viewing Joint Holder Details
Click ‘Joint Holders’ button to view the ‘Joint Holders’ screen. In this screen, you can view the
joint holders details.
Here you can view the following details:

Joint Holder Code
7-26

Description

Joint Holder Type

Start Date

End Date
7.3.3.10
Viewing Recurring Deposits Details
Click ‘Recurring Deposits Details’ button to view the ‘RD Details’ screen. In this screen, you can
view recurring deposits if the deposit is recurring.
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can view the following details:

Frequency Days

Frequency Months

Frequency Years

Installment amount

Payment Branch

Payment Currency

Payment Date
7-27
7.3.3.11
Viewing Redemption Details
Click ‘Redemption Details’ button to view the ‘Redemption Details’ screen. In this screen, you can
view redemption deposits of a deposit account.
7-28
Here you can view the following details:

Redemption Date

Redemption Amount

Principal Amount

Interest Amount

Penal Interest Amount
7.3.3.12
Viewing Joint holder Details
Click ‘Joint Holders’ button to view the ‘Joint Holders’ screen. In this screen, you can view the
joint holders details.
Here you can view the following:
7.3.3.13

Joint Holder Code

Description

Joint Holder Type

Start Date

End Date
Viewing Schedule Details
Click ‘Schedules’ button to view the ‘Schedule Details’ screen. In this screen, you can view the
schedule details of all components attached to the corporate deposit contract.
7-29
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can view the following details:

Component

Component Description

Schedule Type

Frequency

Unit

No of schedules

Start date

Amount
7.3.4 Viewing Loan Details
Click ‘Loans’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
customer’s loan.
7-30
The screen is as shown below:
The loans details are classified as follows:

Commitment Details

Loan Details

Mortgage

Leasing

Syndicate Loans details
Under each of the loan details, the system displays the following:

Branch Code

Account Number

Description

Currency

Amount Financed

Amount Disbursed

Outstanding Amount

Book Date

Value date

Maturity Date
7-31

Product Code

Account Status

User Defined Status
7.3.4.1 Viewing Component Details
You can view details about the components linked to an account in the ‘Component Details’
screen. You can invoke this screen by clicking the ‘Component Details’ button in the ‘360 Degree
Retail Customer View’ screen.
You can view the following component details:

Component Name

Component Currency

Expected – the system displays the amount which is not due for the present date. This
amount is arrived during querying.

Overdue – – the system displays the amount which is not overdue for the present date.
This amount is arrived during querying

Outstanding – the system displays the amount which is due for the present date. This
amount is arrived during querying.

Advance – the system displays the amount pre paid for a component as on the present
date. This amount is arrived during querying.

Latest Interest rate – the system display the current interest rate only for main interest
component.
7-32

Number of Days Overdue.
Component Schedule details
Here you can view the following:

Component Name

Schedule Due Date

Due amount

Settled Amount

EMI Amount

Accrued Amount
7.3.4.2 Viewing Collection Details
You can view the collection details of a loan in the ‘Collection Details of Default Loan’ screen. You
can invoke this screen by clicking the ‘Collection Details’ button in the ‘360 Degree Retail
Customer View’ screen.
Here, you can view the following details:

Collection reference Number

Asset Reference Number

Collection Agent

Collection Creation Date

Queue ID

State
7-33

Product
7.3.5 Viewing Events Details
Click ‘Events’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
upcoming events.
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can view the following details:

Event

Branch

Reference Number

Currency

Amount

Event date
7.3.6 Viewing Schemes Details
Click ‘Schemes’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
relationship schemes.
7-34
The screen is as shown below:
Here, you can view the relationship schemes which are not linked to the customer. The following
fields are displayed:

Pricing scheme Id

Pricing scheme Id description

Scheme Start Date

Scheme End Date

Eligibility Plan code
7.3.6.1 Viewing Relationship pricing schemes linked to the customer
Click ‘RP Scheme Linkage Details’ to view relation ship pricing schemes linked to the customer.
7-35
The screen is as shown below:
Refer ‘Relationship Pricing’ module for more information about this screen.
7.3.7 Viewing Alerts
Click ‘Alerts’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the alerts for overdue
loans, matured deposits and so on.
7-36
Following alerts can be viewed in this screen:
Overdue Loans
Here you can view the Loan accounts which have overdue component as on today. The following
details can be viewed here:

Branch Code

Account number

Due Date

Currency

Overdue Amount
Deposits Matured but not renewed or liquidated
Here you can view the deposit accounts or contracts which are matured but not yet liquidated or
renewed. The following details can be viewed here:

Branch code

Deposit reference number

Currency

Amount

Maturity Date
Locker Charges Overdue Details
Here you can view the Locker charge components of the customer which fall on overdue. The
following details can be viewed here:

Contract Reference Number

Component

Description

Currency

Amount

Due date
Cheques Returned
Here you can view the cheques returned to the customer. The following details can be viewed
here:
7-37

Branch

Account

Cheque Book Number

Cheque Number

Presentation Date
7-38
Amount Block Details
Here you can view all active amount blocks related to a customer. The following details can be
viewed here

Branch

Account

Amount Block Number

Amount

Effective Date

Expiry date

Block Type
Stop Payments Details
Here you can view active stop payments created for the customer. The following details can be
viewed here

Branch

Account

Stoppayment Number

Stoppayment Type

Start Cheque Number

End Cheque Number

Effective date

Expiry Date

Amount

Confirmed flag
7.3.8 Viewing Limits Details
Click ‘Limits’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the limits and
collaterals of the customer.
7-39
The screen is as shown below:
Limits Details
Here the system displays the following limits details:

Customer/Group ID

Limit Currency

Limit Amount

Utilization Amount

Available

Revision Date
Line Details
Here the system displays the following line details:

Line Identification

Main Line

Limit Currency

Limit Amount

Available Amount

Revolving Line

Line Start Date
7-40

Line Expiry Date
Collateral Details
Here the system displays the following collateral details:

Collateral Code

Collateral Description

Collateral Currency

Collateral Value

Lendable Margin

Limit Contribution

Start Date

End date
7.3.9 Viewing Payment Details
Click ‘Payments’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view the FT and PC
contracts of the customer which is not liquidated.
Funds Transfer Details
Here you can view the following Funds Transfer details:

Contract Reference Number
7-41

Product Description

Credit Account Branch

Credit Account

Credit Currency

Credit Amount

Credit value date

Debit Account Branch

Debit Account

Debit currency

Debit amount

Debit Value Date

By order of

Ultimate Beneficiary

Product Code
Payments and Collection Details
Here you can view the following payments and collection details:

Contract Reference Number

Product Description

Account No

Customer Account Branch

Counterparty Bank code

Cpty account number

Cpty Name

Transaction currency

Transaction Amount

Booking Date

Customer Entry Value Date

Counterparty Entry Value date

Network

Product Code
7.3.10 Viewing Islamic Deposits Details
7-42
Click ‘Is-Deposits’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view details about
active CASA account and Term deposit.
Islamic Accounts
Here, you can view the following details for an active CASA account:

Branch code

Account

Description

Account Class

Related Customer

Account Status

Status Since

Currency

Current Balance

Available Balance

Uncollected amount

Blocked amount

Debit Interest Accrued Amount

Credit Interest Accrued Amount

Limit Currency
7-43

TOD Limit

TOD Limit Start Date

TOD Limit End Date

Account Type(Single or Joint)
Closed accounts will not be displayed.
Islamic Term Deposit
The following details about Islamic term deposit will be displayed:

Account Number

Branch Code

Description

Account Class

Related Customer

Status

Since

Currency

Term Deposit Amount

Maturity date

Interest Start Date

Account type(Joint or single)

Tenor – Tenor will be displayed in terms of days.

Profit rate – the system displays the Profit Rate of a deposit. System will pick up the
latest profit rate of a deposit during query.

Latest Profit Effective Date – the system will pick up latest profit effective date of a
deposit during query.

Profit Accrued – Interest accrued till date for an account. This will be derived by the
system during query.

Recurring Deposit- this check box will be checked if it is Recurring Deposit.
7.3.11 Viewing Islamic Financing Details
7-44
Click ‘Is-Financing’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view details about
Islamic Finance.
Here you can view the following details:

Branch code

Account Number

Customer ID

Product Code

Product Type

Description

Currency

Amount financed

Amount Disbursed

Amount outstanding

Book Date

Value date

Maturity Date

Account Status

User defined Status
7-45
7.3.11.1
Viewing Component Details
You can view details about the components linked to an account in the ‘Component Details’
screen. You can invoke this screen by clicking the ‘Component Details’ button in the ‘360 Degree
Retail Customer View’ screen.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Components Details’ under ‘Viewing Loan Details’ for further
details.
7.3.12 Viewing External Details
Click ‘External products’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Retail Customer View’ screen to view external
details about products like credit cards, insurance, and mutual fund.
7-46
The screen is as shown below:
Credit Card
Here you can view the following credit card details:

Card Number

Card Type

Credit Limit

Billed Amount

Min Amount Due

Available Limit

Due Date

Delinquent(Y/N)

Processing Date
Insurance
Here you can view the following insurance details:

Product name

Policy Number

Number of units
7-47

NAV

Insured Amount

Premium Amount

Purchase date

Term

Maturity date

Next Premium Date

Processing Date
Mutual Fund
Here you can view the following mutual fund details:
7.4

Name of Fund

Number of units

Purchase NAV

Billed Amount

Min amount Due

Processing Date
Viewing 360Degree Corporate Customer Details
You can invoke ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen if the customer is Corporate by
double clicking on the customer record in the ‘360Degree Customer View Entry Point’ screen or
by typing ‘STDCUSVW’ in the field at the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking
on the adjoining arrow button.
7-48
The screen is as shown below:
The system displays the following details:

Customer Number

Short Name

Reporting Currency

Branch

Full Name
Click the ‘Reports’ button to view the ‘360 Degree Customer Report’ screen.
7-49
The details that can be viewed in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen is classified
into 16 broad heads.
Summary
You can view the address, status. Balance sheet asset and
liabilities and off balance sheet asset and liabilities under the
summary tab.
Profile
You can view the details of the customer’s profile.
Deposits
You can view the details of the customer deposits.
Loans
You can view the details of the customer’s loan.
Trade
You can view trade details
Treasury
You can view the details of Treasury.
Events
You can view the details of the upcoming events.
Schemes
You can to view the details of the relationship schemes.
Alerts
You can view the alerts for overdue loans, matured deposits
but not renewed or liquidated, Locker Charges Overdue
Details, cheques returned, amount block details and stop
payment details.
Limits
You can view the limits and collaterals of the customer.
Payments
You can view the FT and PC contracts of the customer which
is not liquidated.
Is-Deposits
You can view details about active CASA Account and Islamic
Term Deposit.
IsFinancing
You can view details about Islamic Finance.
Is-Trade
You can view Islamic trade details.
Is-Treasury
You can the details of Islamic Treasury.
External
Products
You can view external details about products like credit
cards, insurance, and mutual fund.
7.4.1 Viewing Summary Details
7-50
You can view the address, status. Balance sheet asset and liabilities and off balance sheet asset
and liabilities under the summary tab.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Summary Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.2 Viewing Profile Details
Click ‘Profile’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
customer’s profile.
Registration Address
Here you can view the following details:

Name

Country

National Id

Address Line 1 to 3

First Name

Middle Name

Last name
7-51
Geographic
Here you can view the following details:

Country

Language

Exposure

Location

SWIFT Code
Incorporation
Here you can view the following details:

Date

Capital

Net Worth

Country

Currency of Amount
Head Office
Here you can view the following details:

Account Number

Debtor Category

Risk profile

FT Accounting as of

Description of Business
7-52
7.4.2.1 Viewing Signature Image and Photograph of the customer
Click on the ‘Image’ button to invoke ‘Customer Signatory Details’ screen. Here you can view the
signature image and photograph of the customer.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Signature Image and Photograph of the customer’ under ‘Viewing
360 Degree Retail Customer Details’ for further details.
7.4.2.2 Viewing Related Customer Details
Click on the ‘Linked Customers’ button to invoke ‘Linked Entities’ screen. Here you can view other
related customer details.
The screen is as shown below:
7-53
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Related Customer Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail
Customer Details’ for further details
7.4.2.3 Viewing Locker Details
Click on the ‘Locker Details’ button to invoke ‘Safe Deposit Locker Details’ screen. Here you can
view the locker details of the customer.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Locker Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details
7.4.2.4 Viewing Director Details
Click on the ‘Directors’ button to invoke ‘Directors’ screen. Here you can view the director details
of the customer.
Here you can view the following details:




Director Name
Customer No
Tax ID
Mobile Number
7-54



E-mail
Mailing Address 1 to 4
Permanent Address 1 to 3
7.4.2.5 Viewing Customer Entities
Click the ‘Linked Entity’ button to invoke ‘Linked Entity’ screen. Here you can view details about
customers who are linked to this customer, accounts for which this customer is linked, and loans
which are guaranteed by this customer.
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Customer Entities’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details
7.4.2.6 Viewing KYC Details
Click the ‘KYC Details’ button to invoke ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen. Here you can view KYC
details of the customer.
7-55
The screen is as shown below:
Refer Core Entities for more information about the ‘KYC Maintenance’ screen.
7.4.2.7 Viewing User Defined Fields
Click on the ‘Fields’ button to invoke ‘User Defined Fields’ screen. Here you can view the UDF
details of the customer.
7-56
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing User Defined Fields’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.2.8 Viewing MIS Details
Click on the ‘MIS’ button to invoke ‘MIS’ screen. Here you can view the MIS details of the
customer.
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing MIS Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer Details’
for further details.
7.4.3 Viewing Deposits Details
Click ‘Deposits’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
customer deposits.
7-57
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Deposit Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details
7.4.3.1 Viewing Account Signatory
Click ‘Account Signatory’ button to view the ‘Signatory Details’ screen. In this screen, you can
view the signatory details of the selected account.
7-58
Refer the section ‘Specifying Account Signatory Details’ under the ‘Current and Savings Account’
module for more information.
7.4.3.2 Viewing Standing Instruction
Click ‘Standing Instruction’ button to view the ‘Standing Instruction Details’ screen. In this screen
you can view the standing instructions.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Standing Instruction ’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail
Customer Details’ for further details.
7.4.3.3 Viewing Periodic Instructions
Click ‘Periodic Instructions’ button to view the ‘Periodic Instructions’ screen. In this screen, you
can view the period instructions.
7-59
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Periodic Instructions’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail
Customer Details’ for further details.
7.4.3.4 Viewing Transactions
Click ‘Transactions’ button to view the ‘Customer Account Transaction Query’ screen. In this
screen, you can query the transactions of an account during a given period.
Refer the section ‘Querying Accounting Entries’ under ‘Core Services’ module for more
information.
7.4.3.5 Viewing Cheques
Click ‘Cheques’ button to view the ‘Cheque Details’ screen. In this screen, you can view the
details of the cheques which are issued for a given period.
7-60
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Cheques’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer Details’
for further details.
7.4.3.6 Viewing Statement Generation
Click ‘Statement Generation’ button to view the ‘Account Statement Report’ screen. In this
screen, you can generate adhoc statement for an account.
7-61
Refer the section ‘Account Statement Report’ under ‘Current and Savings Account’ module for
more information.
7.4.3.7 Viewing Card Details
Click ‘Cards’ button to view the ‘Debit Card Details’ screen. In this screen, you can view details
about active debit cards which are issued during given period for an account.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Card Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.3.8 Viewing Other Details
Click ‘Others’ button to view the ‘Other Details Of Account’ screen. In this screen, you can view
additional details about interest, limit, statement, account and nominees.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Other Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7-62
7.4.3.9 Viewing Customer Signatory
Click ‘Account Signatory’ button to view the ‘Customer Signatory Details’ screen. In this screen,
you can view the signature image and photograph of the customer.
7.4.3.10
Viewing Recurring Deposits Details
Click ‘Recurring Deposits Details’ button to view the ‘RD Details’ screen. In this screen, you can
view recurring deposits if the deposit is recurring.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Recurring Deposits Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail
Customer Details’ for further details.
7-63
7.4.3.11
Viewing Redemption Details
Click ‘Redemption Details’ button to view the ‘Redemption Details’ screen. In this screen, you can
view redemption deposits of a deposit account.
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Redemption Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.3.12
Viewing Schedule Details
Click ‘Schedules’ button to view the ‘Schedule Details’ screen. In this screen, you can view the
schedule details of all components attached to the corporate deposit contract.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Schedule Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.4 Viewing Loan Details
7-64
Click ‘Loans’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
customer’s loan.
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Loans Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.4.1 Viewing Component Details
You can view details about the components linked to an account in the ‘Component Details’
screen. You can invoke this screen by clicking the ‘Component Details’ button in the ‘360 Degree
Corporate Customer View’ screen.
7-65
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Component Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.4.2 Viewing Collection Details
You can view the collection details of a loan in the ‘Collection Details of Default Loan’ screen. You
can invoke this screen by clicking the ‘Collection Details’ button in the ‘360 Degree Corporate
Customer View’ screen.
7-66
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Collection Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.5 Viewing Trade Details
Click ‘Trade’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of trade.
Bills Detail
Here you can view the following bills details:

Branch Code

Contract Reference Number

Counter party

Product

Product Type

Product Description

Beneficiary

Bill Currency

Bill Amount

Maturity date

Outstanding Amount

Discrepancy Flag – System will derive this flag based on the availability of discrepancies
of bill.
7-67

Exception Flag – System will derive this flag based on exception data.

LC Reference Number

Contract Status
LC Details
Here you can view the following details relating to Letters of credits:

Branch Code

Contract reference number

Product Code

Product Type

Product description

Currency

Contract Amount

Customer

Beneficiary

Current Available Amount

Liability

Contract Status

Expiry date
Guarantee Details
Here you can view the following details relating to guarantees:

Branch Code

Contract reference number

Product Code

Product Type

Product description

Currency

Contract Amount

Customer

Beneficiary

Current Available Amount
7-68

Liability

Contract Status

Expiry date

Guarantee Type
7.4.5.1 Viewing Additional Bills Details
You can view additional details about the bill from the ‘Bills Other Details’ screen. You can invoke
this screen by clicking on ‘Other Bill Details’ button.
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can view the following details:

Base date

Value Date

Liquidation Date

Tenor

Operation
7-69

Reimbursement Days

Loan Linkage Flag – System will derive this flag based on the loan details of a bill.

Interest Rate – Current Interest Rate of a bill. System picks up during query.

Interest Accrued – Interest accrued till date. System will derive this value during query.
Discrepancy Details
Here you can view the following details:

Discrepancy Description

Resolved
Loan Details
The loans which are related to Bills will be displayed here. The following fields will be displayed:

Account

Currency

Amount

Down Payment
7.4.5.2 Viewing Additional LC Details
You can view additional details about LC in the ‘LC Additional Details’ screen. You can invoke
this screen by clicking on ‘LC Other Details’ button.
7-70
The screen is as shown below:
Here you can view the following details:

Operation Code

Issue date

Closing Date

Effective date
Commission Details
Here you can view the following details:

Component
7-71

Currency

Amount

Good Until Date

Event Sequence Number
Bill Linkage details
Here you can view the following details:

BC Reference Number

Currency

Amount
Loan Details
Here you can view the Loans details which are related to LC. The following fields are displayed:

Account

Currency

Amount

Down Payment
7-72
7.4.5.3 Viewing Additional Guarantee Details
You can view additional details about guarantee in the ‘Guarantee Additional Details’ screen. You
can invoke this screen by clicking on ‘Guarantee Other Details’ button
Here you can view the following details:

Operation Code

Issue date

Closing Date

Effective date

Guarantee Type
Commission Details
Here you can view the following details:

Component

Component Description

Currency
7-73

Amount

Good Until Date

Event Sequence Number
Loan Details
Here you can view the Loans details which are related to guarantee. The following fields are
displayed:

Account

Currency

Amount

Down Payment
7.4.6 Viewing Treasury Details
Click ‘Treasury’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of
Treasury.
Foreign Exchange Details
Here you can view the following details:

Contract Reference

Buy/sell
7-74

Book Date

Bought Currency

Bought Amount

Bought Value date

Sold Currency

Sold Amount

Sold Value date

Deal Rate
Money Markets Details
Here you can view the following details:

Branch Code

Contract Reference Number

Related Customer

Currency

Amount

Tenor

Book Date

Value Date

Maturity Date

Type(Borrowing or Placement)
Security Portfolio
Here you can view the following details:

Portfolio reference

Portfolio Description

Currency

Auto Liquidate for corporate Actions

Corpus Account

Short Position Allowed

Accrue Withholding Tax for Coupons

Bankers Acceptance
7-75
Derivatives
Here you can view the following details:

Contract Reference number

Buy or Sell

In Leg Currency

Out Leg Currency

In Principal Amount

Out Principal Amount

Book Date

Value Date

Maturity Date

Type
OTC Options
Here you can view the following details:

Contract Reference Number

Related Customer

Currency

Contract Amount

Strike Price

Premium Currency

Option Premium

Premium Pay date

Buy or sell

Tenor

Book Date

Value date

Maturity date

Type
ETD Portfolio Details
Here you can view the following details:
7-76

Portfolio Reference Number

Portfolio Description

Fund Id
7.4.7 Viewing Events Details
Click ‘Events’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of the
upcoming events.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Events Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.8 Viewing Schemes Details
Click ‘Schemes’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of
the relationship schemes.
7-77
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Schemes Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.8.1 Viewing Relationship pricing schemes linked to the customer
Click ‘RP Scheme Linkage Details’ to view relation ship pricing schemes linked to the customer.
Refer ‘Relationship Pricing’ module for more information about this screen.
7-78
7.4.9 Viewing Alerts
Click ‘Alerts’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the alerts for
overdue loans, matured deposits and so on.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Alerts Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.10 Viewing Limits Details
Click ‘Limits’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the limits and
collaterals of the customer.
7-79
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Limits Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.11 Viewing Payment Details
7-80
Click ‘Payments’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the FT and PC
contracts of the customer which is not liquidated.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Payments Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7.4.12 Viewing Islamic Deposits
7-81
Click ‘Is-Deposits’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view details about
active CASA account and term deposit.
7-82
7.4.12.1
Viewing Additional Islamic Bill Details
You can view additional details about the bill from the ‘Bills Other Details’ screen. You can invoke
this screen by clicking on ‘Other Bill Details’ button.
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Additional Bill Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Corporate
Customer Details’ for further details.
7-83
7.4.12.2
Viewing Additional Islamic LC Details
You can view additional details about LC in the ‘LC Additional Details’ screen. You can invoke
this screen by clicking on ‘LC Other Details’ button.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Additional LC Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Corporate
Customer Details’ for further details.
7.4.12.3
Viewing Additional Islamic Bank Guarantee Details
You can view additional details about guarantee in the ‘Guarantee Additional Details’ screen. You
can invoke this screen by clicking on ‘Guarantee Other Details’ button.
7-84
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Additional Islamic Bank Guarantee’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree
Corporate Customer Details’ for further details.
7-85
7.4.13 Viewing Is-Financing Details
Click ‘Is-Financing’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view details of
Islamic finance.
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Islamic Financing Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail
Customer Details’ for further details.
7-86
7.4.13.1
Viewing Component Details
You can view details about the components linked to an account in the ‘Component Details’
screen. You can invoke this screen by clicking the ‘Component Details’ button in the ‘360 Degree
Corporate Customer View’ screen.
The screen is as shown below:
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing Components Details’ under ‘Viewing Loan Details’ for further
details.
7-87
7.4.14 Viewing Islamic Trade Details
Click ‘Is-Trade’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view details of Islamic
trade.
The screen is as shown below:
Islamic Bills Detail
Here you can view the following bills details:

Branch Code

Contract Reference Number

Counter party

Product

Product Type

Product Description

Beneficiary

Bill Currency

Bill Amount

Maturity date

Outstanding Amount
7-88

Discrepancy Flag – System will derive this flag based on the availability of discrepancies
of bill.

Exception Flag – System will derive this flag based on exception data.

Our LC Reference Number

Contract Status
Islamic Letter of Credit Details
Here you can view the following details relating to Letters of credits:

Branch Code

Contract reference number

Product Code

Product Type

Product description

Currency

Contract Amount

Customer

Beneficiary

Current Available Amount

Liability

Contract Status

Expiry date
Islamic Bank Guarantee Details
Here you can view the following details relating to guarantees:

Branch Code

Contract reference number

Product Code

Product Type

Product description

Currency

Contract Amount

Customer

Beneficiary
7-89

Current Available Amount

Liability

Contract Status

Expiry date

Guarantee Type
7.4.15 Viewing Islamic Treasury Details
Click ‘Is-Treasury’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view the details of
Islamic Treasury.
The screen is as shown below:
Islamic Money Market Details
Here you can view the following details:

Branch Code

Contract Reference

Currency

Amount

Book Date

Maturity Date
7-90

Value Date

Tenor

Type
Islamic Derivatives
Here you can view the following details:

Contract Reference

Buy

In Leg Currency

In Principal Amount

Out Leg Currency

Out Principal Amount

Book Date

Value date

Maturity

Type
7.4.16 Viewing External Details
Click ‘External products’ tab in the ‘360 Degree Corporate Customer View’ screen to view
external details about products like credit cards, insurance, and mutual fund.
7-91
Refer the section titled ‘Viewing External Details’ under ‘Viewing 360 Degree Retail Customer
Details’ for further details.
7-92
8. Glossary
8.1
Important Terms
Account Class
A group of customer accounts with similar characteristics and attributes
Account Statement Cycle
The periodicity for the generation of account statements
Account Statement Type
An indicator of the kind of account statement required to be generated periodically; this could be
either a summary statement or a detailed one.
Alternate Account Number
An unique identifier for a customer account, other than the main Account Number. This provision
is made to enable tracking of accounts existing in the bank before the installation of FLEXCUBE.
For such accounts, you can capture the old account numbers as the Alternate Account Numbers.
Available
The amount available in a customer’s account, which can be drawn
Blocked
The amount that is blocked for other transactions, which the customer has entered into and not
executed. At any point of time, the account balance cannot be less than the blocked amount.
Corporate Parameters
Information captured under customized parameters for corporate customers
Customer Category
A group of customers with logically similar features or attributes
Dormancy Days
The period following which customer accounts under a class are made inactive
Exposure Country
This is the country of exposure of a customer. This information is maintained for Central Liability
tracking
8-1
Identifier Name
The name of the identification document furnished by the customer to the bank as proof of
identity
Identifier Value
The serial number, document number or any identification number by which the identifier name
document can be uniquely identified.
Joint Holder Code
The account identifier codes given to joint holders of any customer account
Legal Guardian
If the account holder is a minor, this is the legal guardian of the customer
Liability Number
A code used to keep track of the credit limit facility granted to a customer
Limit Check
A validation maintained for all accounts in an account class to see if there are adequate funds in
the account.
Loan Repayment
The amount paid towards loan repayment
MTD (Month to Date)
Indicates the turnover on an account for the current month and up to the current date. It is
specified for both Credit and Debit turnovers
Narratives
Specifications that help achieve a desired format for account statements
Natural GL
The code of the GL to which the turnovers of all accounts in the account class will be reported.
Regulation D
This is a regulation of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. Regulation D, also known
as "Reg D," exempts certain offerings of equity from many of the regulatory requirements that
impose costs upon standard public offerings. A Reg D offering is intended to make access to the
capital markets possible for small companies that could not otherwise bear those costs.
8-2
Reporting Lines
The general ledger codes to which balances (debit or credit) of all accounts in an account class
will be reported.
Sub-limit
The maximum credit amount that can be used by a customer account without requiring an
override. The sub-limit is specified for accounts for which the credit amount is limited to a part of
the available line amount.
Temporary OD End
The date on which the temporary overdraft limit ceases to be effective
Temporary OD Limit
The maximum overdraft allowed on an account, for a specified period of time
Temporary OD Start
The date on and following which the temporary overdraft limit comes into effect
Tenure
The duration for which a customer has been in professional employment. This information is
captured as part of the professional details for a customer.
Uncollected Funds Limit
On any given business day, the credit transaction amounts that have not been collected.
Unposted Credits
In a multi-branch or online activity (such as tele-banking or Internet banking) transactions that are
posted into an account when the system is either not available or during End of Day run, are
stored, to be posted into the system when the system is available. Credit transactions of this
nature are classified as unposted credits.
Unposted Debits
In a multi-branch or online activity (such as tele-banking or Internet banking) transactions that are
posted into an account when the system is either not available or during End of Day run, are
stored, to be posted into the system when the system is available. Debit transactions of this
nature are classified as unposted debits.
8-3
W-8BEN Form
The W-8BEN form (entitled Certificate of Foreign Status of Beneficial Owner for United States
Tax Withholding) is used in the United States taxation system by foreign persons (including
corporations) to certify their non-American status. The form, issued by the Internal Revenue
Service, establishes that one is a foreign, non-resident alien or foreign national performing work
outside the United States, in order to claim tax treaty benefits such as a lower amount of tax
withholding from dividends paid by U.S. corporations.
9.
9.1
Reports
Introduction
Every action that results in a debit or credit to the customer’s monetary account is recorded. The
advices are generated and sent to the customer depending on the advice generation frequency
that you have specified.
You can generate the following reports:
9.2

IRA Statement

Minimum Withdrawal Advice

Charge Advice

IRS Form 5498

IRS Form 1099-R

Customer Account Opening Confirmation

Netting

Combined Statement Reports

Missing Signature Report
IRA Statement Reports
An IRA statement is a statement of accounts for an IRA plan. You will be able to generate
statements for a list of all the transactions carried out in an IRA plan for the statement generation
frequency specified for the plan. You also have the option of generation on an ad-hoc basis.
9.2.1 Selection Options
You can choose to generate the account statements for transactions involving all plans within
your branch or for transaction within a single plan or for a range of plans.
You will also have to indicate the date range for the generation of the report.
9.2.2 Contents of the Report
9-4
The options that you specified while generating the report are printed at the beginning of the
report. The contents of the IRA Statement have been discussed under the following heads:
Header
The Header carries the title of the Report, information on the branch code, the date and time at
which the report was generated and the page number of the report.
Body of the Report
Customer
Information
The CIF Number, full Name and mailing address of the
customer as recorded in the CIF Maintenance screen
Plan Number
The reference number of the plan involving the transaction
Plan Type
The plan type involving the plan
Period of the
statement
The period for which you are generating the statement
Statement
Number
The statement number of the statement
Plan Balances
The balances in the plan at the beginning and end of
statement period (Current and Previous Years)
Note:
The current balance is reflected for the current year and the
year ending balance (after considering contributions and
distributions done during the current year for the previous
year) for the previous year.
Total Contributions
Excess Contributions
Total Distributions
Total Employer Contributions (where applicable)
Excess Employer Contributions
Transaction
Information
Transaction type (Contributions, Distributions, Monetary
Account Interest).
Transaction Reference Number
Amount and Currency
Transaction Year
Monetary Account Breakup
9-2
Customer
Information
The CIF Number, full Name and mailing address of the
customer as recorded in the CIF Maintenance screen
Account (Branch, Account, Currency)
Amount and Currency
Withholding Tax information (where applicable)
Tax Withheld (Amount and Currency)
Transaction Remark (if any)
Plan Balance after the transaction (current and previous
year balances)
Transactions are sequenced in the manner in which they
were processed in the system.
9.3
Minimum Withdrawal Advice Reports
This advice is sent to all customers approaching the minimum distribution age. The advice
contains information about all the plans held by the customer under the plan type.
Since it is not generated automatically, you have to invoke the advice generation screen and
identify the Plan Type and the Reference Number of the plan involving the plan type for which the
minimum distribution age advice is to be generated.
9.3.1 Contents of the Report
Apart from the header the following details are printed for the report:
Body of the Report
Customer
Information
The CIF Number, full Name and mailing address of the
customer as recorded in the CIF Maintenance screen.
Plan Type
The plan type involving the plan.
Plans Held
This information includes:
Plan Number.
Plan Balances (current year only)
Plan Balance
Total Contributions
Excess Contributions
Total Distributions
9-3
Total Employer Contributions (where applicable)
Excess Employer Contributions
Plan Remarks (if any)
9.4
Charge Advice Reports
This advice is sent to all customers on whom you are levying a charge as a result of the IRA
Charge set-up. The system generates this advice automatically as part of the EOD processes on
the day the charge liquidation takes place.
9.4.1 Contents of the Report
Apart from the header the following details are printed for the report:
Body of the Report
Customer
Information
The CIF Number, full Name and mailing address of the
customer as recorded in the CIF Maintenance screen.
Charge Code
The Code associated with the Charge for which you are
charging the customer.
Charge Level
Indicates the level at which charging is being done:
CIF Level or
Plan level
9.5
Plan Type
The plan type involving the plan.
Charge Amount and
Currency
The charge is always charged in the local currency of your
branch.
Liquidation Date
The date on which the charge amount was liquidated.
Debit Account
Information
The Branch, Account Number and Currency of the account
involved in the transaction.
IRS Form 5498
9-4
Oracle FLEXCUBE allows you to generate Form 5498 for reporting contributions to IRA plans for
any year to the Internal Revenue Service (IRS). You can generate this report for:

Filing with IRS authorities;

Providing a copy to your customer;

Keeping an internal copy for you.
You can generate Form 5498 either as part of initial filing with the IRS or after you have filed tax
returns for that particular year.
9.5.1 Generating Form 5498 as Part of Initial Filing
During normal generation of Form 5498 as part of your initial filing with the IRS, the system will
include all transactions entered in the previous year for the previous year. For example, during
normal generation of Form 5498 on, say, January 20, 2003, all transactions entered during 2002
and pertaining to the financial year 2002 will be reported.
9.5.2 Generating Form 5498 after Tax Filing
During corrected generation post the date of tax filing, the system will include, apart from all the
transactions included in normal generation, such transactions which are entered in the current
year for the previous year. The report shows the total contributions for the year.
9.5.3 Details printed on Form 5498
Oracle FLEXCUBE generates Form 5498 customer-wise and plan-wise – that is, for each
customer for each type of plan held by the customer. The type of plan can be Traditional IRA,
Roth IRA, SEP, SIMPLE, etc.
The form contains the following details:

Your bank’s name and address;

The customer’s name, social security number and address;

The plan/product type for which the form is being generated;

The year for which the report is being generated;

Total rollover contributions – this is the total of all contributions into plans of the selected
type with ‘Rollover’ as the contribution code;

Roth IRA conversion amount – while usually applicable for Roth IRAs, this, in the general
case, is the total contribution into plans of the selected type with ‘Conversion’ as the
contribution code;

Total re-characterized contributions – this is the total of all contributions into plans of the
selected type with ‘Re-characterization’ as the contribution code;

New contributions – this is the total of all contributions into plans of the selected type with
‘New’ as the contribution code;
9-5

Other contributions – this is the total of all contributions into plans of the selected type
with contribution codes different from any of those mentioned above;

Fair Market Value – this is the total year-end balance of all the plans of the selected type.
IRA codes that you have marked for not reporting to the IRS will be left out of all of the above
summations.
9.6
IRS Form 1099-R
Oracle FLEXCUBE allows you to generate Form 1099-R for reporting distributions from a
selected type of IRA plan for any year to the Internal Revenue Service (IRS). You can generate
this report for:

Filing with IRS authorities;

Providing a copy to your customer;

Keeping an internal copy for you.
You can generate Form 1099-R either as part of initial filing with the IRS or after you have filed
tax returns for that particular year.
9.6.1 Generating Form 1099-R as Part of Initial Filing
During normal generation of Form 1099-R as part of your initial filing with the IRS, the system will
include all transactions entered in the previous year for the previous year. For example, during
normal generation of Form 1099-R on, say, January 20, 2003, all transactions entered during
2002 and pertaining to the financial year 2002 will be reported.
9.6.2 Generating Form 1099-R after Tax Filing
During corrected generation post the date of tax filing, the system will include, apart from all the
transactions included in normal generation, such transactions, which are entered in the current
year for the previous year. The report shows the total contributions for the year.
9.6.3 Details printed on Form 1099-R
Oracle FLEXCUBE generates Form 1099-R for each customer for a distribution code. You have
the option of combining distributions with the same code from any number of different
plan/product types.
IRA codes that you have marked for not reporting to the IRS will not be available for
generation of 1099-R forms.
Form 1099-R contains the following details:

Your bank’s name, address and identification number;

The customer’s name, social security number and address;
9-6

Plan/product types that are being reported;

The distribution code and description;

Gross distribution – this is the total distribution amount for the distribution code that you
have chosen across all the selected plan types;

Taxable amount – this is the same as the total (gross) distribution amount.

Total distribution – this is a confirmation that the gross distribution amount mentioned in
the form is the total distribution for the selected distribution code.

Federal Income Tax withheld – this is the total amount withheld as tax for all the
distributions (from all the selected plan/product types) for the selected distribution code.
9.6.4 Filing IRS Forms Electronically
IRS regulations stipulate that any entity filing 250 or more forms of each type must do so in
electronic or magnetic form. You can access IRS’s Filing Information Returns Electronically
(FIRE) system over a dial-up network and through a browser or through communication software
like ProComm. You can log on to the system using the logon name, password and PIN provided
to you by the IRS.
9.7
Customer Account Opening Confirmation Report
You can generate a report for the customer, confirming that his / her account with the bank has
been successfully opened. This report contains the following details:

Customer number

Client account number

Matter

Account details
You can generate the Customer Account Opening Confirmation report for one customer or all the
customers at once, as of a specific date. To generate the report, invoke ‘Customer Account
Opening Confirmation’ screen.
You can invoke this screen by typing the code ‘CSRPACCO’ in the field at the top right corner of
the Application tool bar and click on the adjoining arrow button.
9-7
The screen is as shown below:
Customer Report
You can generate customer account opening confirmation report for one or all the customers.
Indicate your choice here. If you select ‘Single Customer’, you have to specify the customer
number in the space provided.
Customer Number
If you wish to generate a report specific to one customer, specify the customer number. The
option list displays all valid customer numbers maintained in the system. Select the appropriate
one.
Date
Specify the date as of which you want to generate the report.
Once you have set the preferences, click ‘OK’ button. The system displays the print option
screen, where you can set your preferences as to viewing and printing the report.
9.8
Netting Report
You can generate a Customer, Currency and Date wise report to retrieve details of
contracts/amounts that were netted.
You can specify the following preferences for the report:

Report Type - You can indicate whether the report should contain details of
contracts/amounts that have the same Value Date or whether the details should be
generated as per the Netting Reference Number. If you indicate that the report should be
generated for a Netting Reference Number you will have to identify the number in the
respective field.
9-8

Date – indicate whether you would like to generate the report for a specific date range or
for all dates. Depending on your specification the netting details report will be generated
for all contracts that were netted within your branch for the given date range (start and
end date inclusive) or it will be generated for all contracts regardless of the date on which
they were netted.

Customer – indicate whether the report should contain details of all customers whose
contracts were netted or for a single customer. For a single customer you will have to
identify the CIF ID of the customer from the option list.

Currency - You can indicate whether the report should be generated for all currencies or
for a specific currency. Identify the currency for which the report should be generated in
case of a single currency.
Note

If you fail to specify a date, the generated report will return data for the Current System
Date.

If you indicate that the report should be generated for a specific Currency and fail to
specify the Currency, the report will contain details of all currencies. Similarly, if you
indicate that the report should be generated for a specific Customer and fail to identify the
customer the report will be generated for all customers.
9.8.1 Contents of the Report
The report options that you selected while generating the report are printed at the beginning of
the report.
The contents of the report are discussed below:
Body of the Report
9.9
Counterparty
This is the name of the counterparty whose netted
contract details are being displayed.
Contract Reference
Number
This is the reference number of the contract which was
netted.
Component
This is the name of the component (Amount Tag)
involved in the transaction.
Amount
This is the amount for which the particular entry was
passed.
Account Due
This is the account to which the netted amount is either
debited/credited.
Combined Statement Reports
This report is an ad-hoc combined statement of accounts for a customer, generated for a
particular period. This report is grouped account class wise. This report helps in providing a single
statement to the customers who own multiple accounts.
9-9
You can invoke ‘Statement of Combined Generation’ screen by typing ‘CIRCSTAD’ in the field at
the top right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking on the adjoining arrow button.
The screen is as shown below:
Specify the following details here:
Branch Code
Select the branch code from the adjoining option-list. The list displays all valid branch codes.
Customer No
Select the customer number from the adjoining option-list. This list displays all valid customers
maintained in the system.
From Date
Select the From date for statement generation. By default the current application date is
displayed here.
To Date
Select the To date for statement generation. By default the current application date is displayed
here.
Click ‘OK’ button to generate the report. Click ‘Exit’ to return to the Reports Browser.
9.9.1 Contents of the Report
The contents of the report are discussed under the following heads:
9-10
Header
The header carries the Customer Name, Customer Address, Account Class, Account Number,
Opening balance, Currency and Branch.
Body of the Report
Date of transaction
This indicates the transaction date
Transaction Description
This is the description of the
transaction
Reference
This is the Reference of the
transaction
Credit
This indicates the Credit amount
Debit
This indicates the Debit amount
Balance
This indicates the Balance
Credit Total
This indicates the credit total
Transaction Code
This indicates the code of the
transaction
Debit total
This indicates the debit total
9.10 Missing Signature Report
This is an exception report listing all the customers, of a specified branch, whose signatures have
not yet been captured in the system.
While opening accounts, customer's signature/photographs/thumb impression are captured and
linked to the account. This facilitates the signature verification in the system at the time of making
payment. Branches can generate this ad-hoc report, and capture the missing signature in the
system.
You can invoke ‘Signatures not Captured’ screen by typing ‘CIRSNREP’ in the field at the top
right corner of the Application tool bar and clicking on the adjoining arrow button.
9-11
9-12
Specify the following details here:
Branch Code
Select the branch code from the adjoining option-list. The list displays all valid branch codes.
Click ‘OK’ button to generate the report. Click ‘Exit’ to return to the Reports Browser.
9.10.1 Contents of the Report
The contents of the report are discussed under the following heads:
Header
The Header carries the Branch, Date, User ID and the Module for which the report is generated.
Body of the report
The generated report will have the following information:
Customer ID
This indicates the unique id of
the customer
Customer Name
This indicates the name of the
customer
Open Date
This indicates the date on
which the account is opened
Authorizer ID
This indicates the id of the
authorizer
9-13
10. Screen Glossary
10.1 Function ID List
The following table lists the function id and the function description of the screens covered as part
of this User Manual.
Function ID
Function Description
ACDADCRP
Ad-hoc Report Generation
ACDCBIR
Customer Summary Query
ACDCODQS
Overdrawn Accounts Query
ACDFUNCO
Uncollected Funds Query
ACDSCPQR
Customer Information Query
ACDSQASL
Customer Asset & Liability Query
ACDSQPRO
Customer Projections Query
BADIDBAT
Intra Day Batch Start
CIRCSTAD
Combined Statement Generation
CIRSNREP
Signatures not captured
CODSTTYP
Static Type Maintenance
CSDALGGN
Algorithm Generation Input
CSDALGMT
Algorithm Maintenance
CSDINSTR
Instructions Maintenance
CSDPROVN’
Provisioning Coverage Details
CSDRELMN
Relationship Maintenance
CSDSTNAR
Statement Narratives Maintenance
CSRPACCO
Customer Account Opening Confirmation
CSSINSTR
Instructions Summary
CSSJOBBR
Jobs Browser
LDDECMNT
Corporate Deposits Exposure Category Maintenance
10-1
Function ID
Function Description
LDDETMNT
Corporate Deposits Category Type Maintenance
LDDPRULE
Corporate Deposits Provisioning Rule Maintenance
LDDPRVMN
Corporate Deposits Provisioning Percentage
Maintenance
LDSETMNT
Corporate Deposits Category Type Summary
MSDCUSAD
Customer Address Maintenance
SMDEMPMT
Employer Maintenance
STDACCLS
Account Class Maintenance
STDACLOC
Account Address Location Maintenance
STDACTFR
Account Class Transfer
STDAMDMT
Gateway Amendment Maintenance
STDBALAC
Balance Account Code Maintenance
STDCCMNT
Customer Classification Maintenance
STDCIFNM
Customer Name Maintenance
STDCULMT
Customer Tax Allowance Maintenance
STDCULOC
Location Maintenance
STDCUREL
Customer Linkage Maintenance
STDCUSPR
Customer Prefix Maintenance
STDCUSVW
360 Degree Corporate Customer View
STDCUSST’
Customer Sector Maintenance
STDDOCQU
Customer Document Expiry Query Screen
STDFIEMT
Financial Institution Exemption Maintenance Screen
STDFLTDS
Float Days Maintenance
STDGRMNT
Group Code Maintenance
STDGROUP
Customer Group Maintenance
STDKYCMN
KYC Maintenance
10-2
Function ID
Function Description
STDKYCTP
KYC Type Maintenance
STDLEDMT
Lead Maintenance
STDPRCTY
Province City Maintenance
STDPLMNT
Postal Code and Locality Maintenance Screen
STDREFQU
Referral Queue
STDRELMT
Relation Maintenance
STDRETVW
360 Degree Retail Customer View
STDRKMNT
Risk Category Maintenance
STDSDNMN
Specially Designated Nationals Maintenance
STDSRQST
Service Request Input
STDSTMNT
Manual Status Change Input
STDTAXWV
Tax Waiver Maintenance
STDTOLMT
Turnover Limit Maintenance
STSACTFR
Account Class Transfer
STSCUSVW
360Degree Customer View Entry Point
STSFIEMT
Financial Institution Exemption Summary Screen
STSPRCTY
Province City Summary
STSREFQU
Referral Queue Summary
STSSRQST
Service Request Fetch
10-3
Core Entities
October [2013]
Version 11.3.81.02.0
Oracle Financial Services Software Limited
Oracle Park
Off Western Express Highway
Goregaon (East)
Mumbai, Maharashtra 400 063
India
Worldwide Inquiries:
Phone: +91 22 6718 3000
Fax:+91 22 6718 3001
www.oracle.com/financialservices/
Copyright © [2007], [2013], Oracle and/or its affiliates. All rights reserved.
Oracle and Java are registered trademarks of Oracle and/or its affiliates. Other names may be trademarks of their
respective owners.
U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS: Oracle programs, including any operating system, integrated software, any programs
installed on the hardware, and/or documentation, delivered to U.S. Government end users are "commercial computer
software" pursuant to the applicable Federal Acquisition Regulation and agency-specific supplemental regulations. As
such, use, duplication, disclosure, modification, and adaptation of the programs, including any operating system,
integrated software, any programs installed on the hardware, and/or documentation, shall be subject to license terms and
license restrictions applicable to the programs. No other rights are granted to the U.S. Government.
This software or hardware is developed for general use in a variety of information management applications. It is not
developed or intended for use in any inherently dangerous applications, including applications that may create a risk of
personal injury. If you use this software or hardware in dangerous applications, then you shall be responsible to take all
appropriate failsafe, backup, redundancy, and other measures to ensure its safe use. Oracle Corporation and its affiliates
disclaim any liability for any damages caused by use of this software or hardware in dangerous applications.
This software and related documentation are provided under a license agreement containing restrictions on use and
disclosure and are protected by intellectual property laws. Except as expressly permitted in your license agreement or
allowed by law, you may not use, copy, reproduce, translate, broadcast, modify, license, transmit, distribute, exhibit,
perform, publish or display any part, in any form, or by any means. Reverse engineering, disassembly, or decompilation of
this software, unless required by law for interoperability, is prohibited.
The information contained herein is subject to change without notice and is not warranted to be error-free. If you find any
errors, please report them to us in writing.
This software or hardware and documentation may provide access to or information on content, products and services
from third parties. Oracle Corporation and its affiliates are not responsible for and expressly disclaim all warranties of any
kind with respect to third-party content, products, and services. Oracle Corporation and its affiliates will not be
responsible for any loss, costs, or damages incurred due to your access to or use of third-party content, products, or
services.
10-1
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertisement